Changeset 40899


Ignore:
Timestamp:
09/02/17 23:43:14 (7 years ago)
Author:
obi
Message:

reset wiki

Location:
wiki/pages/nl
Files:
114 edited

Legend:

Unmodified
Added
Removed
  • wiki/pages/nl/AV-Settings

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2>----
     3>'''3.6.1 AV Settings''' [=#point3.6.1] ([wiki:Interface-Operation#point3.6 Settings (Back)]) ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4>
     5>Menu Picture place holder:
     6>
     7>[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/AV-Settings.jpg)]][[BR]]
     8>
     9> here you can setup your audio and visual settings.
     10
     11[[br]]
     12
     13 ||'''Resolution (Default)''' ||Set the default resolution of the decoder.||
     14 ||'''Resolution Current:''' ||Shows the current resolution of the decoder.||
     15 ||'''Auto Resolution:'''  ||Do you want the EPG file to be deleted after being read.||
     16 ||'''Policy:''' ||If the image does not suit the screen format what method shuld the decoder use to best fill the display.||
     17 ||'''Aspect:''' ||Set the aspect ratio of the display.||
     18 ||'''Colour Format''' ||Set the colour format of the hdmi output.||
     19 ||'''Colour Format Scart/ Composite:''' ||Set the colour format of the composite and scart output.||
     20 ||'''Audio Source:''' ||Select the audio source format.||
     21 ||'''Ac3 Default:''' ||Do you wish for the default audio format to be AC3.||
     22 ||'''Ac3 Mode:''' ||Set the output conversion format of the AC3 stream.||
     23 ||'''Audio Delay:''' ||Set the delay or advance time of the audio signal to sync it with the video signal.||
     24 ||'''Inc AC3 Audio in %:''' ||Increace ac3 audio volume in % of total volume.||
     25 ||'''3D Mode:''' ||Output the tv signal in side by side or vertical 3d format.||
     26 ||'''two step mute:''' ||Set the default function of the mute button lower volume then mute or just mute.||
     27 ||'''automatic restart last subtitle:''' ||load the last used subtitle when playing back a recording or stream.||
     28 ||'''Sound ampflier (tv modus/ internal player)''' ||Increace the volume amplification when  watching tv or using the default media player.||
     29 ||'''Sound ampflier (external player)''' ||Increace the volume amplification when  using a third party media player.||
     30 
     31 To __"Store"__ the settings Exit from the EPG Settings Menu by pressing __"OK"__ or press __"Exit"__ to cancel changes.
     32 
     33
     34
     35[[br]]
  • wiki/pages/nl/Backup

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2>----
     3>'''3.5.8 Backup''' [=#point3.5.8] ([wiki:Interface-Operation#point3.5 System (Back)]) ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4>
     5>
     6>
     7>[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/system_backup.jpg)]][[br]]
     8>
     9Here you can run a manual backup to /tmp or /var/backup if there is insufficent free space you can use a usb device.
     10
     11please ensure these folders are installed on the device for the Backup to operate.
     12
     13[[br]]
     14
     15To Exit from the backup menu press __"Exit"__.
     16 
     17[[br]]
     18----
     19
     20 '''Coloured Button's Functions"
     21
     22 The __"Coloured Buttons"__ along the bottom of the display bring up additional menus and options with in the epg settings menu.
     23 please see below for more info on the functions of these buttons:.
     24 
     25 ||'''Red Button: (backup)''' ||This will Start the backup process please follow the onscreen propmps.||
     26
     27[[BR]]
  • wiki/pages/nl/Blind-Scan-Settings

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2>----
     3>'''3.5.1.6 Blind Scan Settings''' [=#point3.5.1.6] ([wiki:Channel-Service#point3.5.1 Channel-Service (Back)]) ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4>
     5>
     6>[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Blind-Scan-Settings.jpg)]][[br]]
     7>
     8Here you can proform a blind scan.
     9
     10[[br]]
     11
     12 ||'''Tuner type''' ||Select the recption tuner type.||
     13 ||'''Minimal Frequency:''' ||Set the mimimum frequency to scan for during blind scan.||
     14 ||'''Maximum Frequency:''' ||Set the maximum frequency to scan for during blind scan.||
     15 ||'''Step Frequency:''' ||Set the step size of the frequency in mhz from the start frequency to scan.||
     16 ||'''Minimal Signalrate:''' ||Set the minimum Signal rate to scan for during blind scan.||
     17 ||'''Maximum Signalrate''' ||Set the Maximum Signal rate to scan for during blind scan.||
     18 ||'''Step Signalrate'''  ||Set the brightness of the led when the system is in standby.||
     19 ||'''Use only standard forward error correction (FEC)''' ||???.||
     20 ||'''DVB-S Services Only:''' ||Scan only for SD channels.||
     21 ||'''Only Default FEC:''' ||???.||
     22
     23 ''note: not all these options are relavant or shown and it depend's on the selected tuner type''
     24   
     25 To __"Store"__ the settings Exit from the EPG Settings Menu by pressing __"OK"__ or press __"Exit"__ to cancel changes.
     26
  • wiki/pages/nl/Blue-Button

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2>----
     3>'''3.6.5 Blue Button''' [=#point3.6.5] ([wiki:Interface-Operation#point3.60 Settings (Back)])([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4>
     5>Menu Picture place holder:
     6>
     7>[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Blue_Button.jpg)]][[BR]]
     8>
     9>here you can configure what happens with the press of the blue button
     10
     11
     12[[br]]
  • wiki/pages/nl/CPU

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2>----
     3>'''3.7.8.6.1 CPU''' [=#point3.7.8.6.1] ([wiki:System-Infos#point3.7.8.6 System Infos (Back])
     4>
     5>
     6>[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/CPU.jpg)]][[br]]
     7>
     8Here you can view the detailed cpu info.
     9
     10[[br]]
     11
     12
     13[[br]]
  • wiki/pages/nl/Change-Feed

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2>----
     3>'''3.4.2 Change Feed''' [=#point3.4.2] ([wiki:Interface-Operation#point3.4 Extentions (Back)]) ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4>
     5>Menu Picture place holder:
     6>
     7>[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Change_Feed.jpg)]][[BR]]
     8>
     9>here you can sett up an aditional feed to obtain extra plugins not found in the online library
     10
     11[[br]]
  • wiki/pages/nl/Channel-Edit

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2>----
     3>'''3.6.15 Channel Edit''' [=#point3.6.15] ([wiki:Interface-Operation#point3.6 Settings (Back)])
     4>
     5>Menu Picture place holder:
     6>
     7>[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Channel_Edit.jpg)]][[BR]]
     8>
     9>here you can edit your channel data
     10
     11
     12[[br]]
     13
     14 ||'''Copy Service:''' ||Enable channel copy mode, this enables the user to copy channels to another boquet.||
     15 ||'''Remove Service:''' ||Enable channel remove mode, this enables the user to remove channels from the currently selected boquet.||
     16 ||'''Move Service:''' ||Enable channel move mode, this enables the user to move channels to another boquet.||
     17 ||'''Protect Service:''' ||Enable channel protect mode, this enables the user to pin protect seletcted channels in the currently selected boquet.||
     18 ||'''Rename Service:''' ||Enable channel rename mode, this enables the user to copy channels to another boquet.||
     19 ||'''Sort Service:''' || selecting this will sort all channels in all boquets by alphebitac order.||
     20 ||'''Set Start Channel:''' ||Here you can set the channel you wish for the receiver to show on startup.||
     21 ||'''Delete Start Channel:''' ||Here you can remove the currently selected startup channel that shows on startup.||
     22 
     23 To __"Store"__ the settings Exit from the EPG Settings Menu by pressing __"OK"__ or press __"Exit"__ to cancel changes.
  • wiki/pages/nl/Channel-Service

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2>----
     3>'''3.5.1 Channel Service''' [=#point3.5.1] ([wiki:Interface-Operation#point3.5 System (Back)]) ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4>
     5>Menu Picture place holder:
     6>
     7>[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/system-Channel_Service.jpg)]][[BR]]
     8>
     9Here you can setup your tuner and proform a channel scan.
     10please select a menu item for more information
     11[[br]]
     12
     13 * ([wiki:Tuner-Configuration#point3.5.1.1 Tuner configuration])
     14 * ([wiki:Automatic-Search#point3.5.1.2 Automatic Search])
     15 * ([wiki:Manual-Search#point3.5.1.3 Manual Search])
     16 * ([wiki:Rotor-Settings#point3.5.1.4 Rotor Settings])
     17 * ([wiki:Sat-Finder#point3.5.1.5 Sat Finder])
     18 * ([wiki:Blind-Scan-Settings#point3.5.1.6 Blind Scan Settings])
     19 * ([wiki:Create-Transponder-List#point3.5.1.7 Create Transponder List])
     20 * ([wiki:Create-Default-Favorites#point3.5.1.8 Create Default Favorites])
     21
     22
     23[[br]]
     24
  • wiki/pages/nl/Child-Protection

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2>----
     3>'''3.6.12 Child Protection''' [=#point3.6.12] ([wiki:Interface-Operation#point3.6 Settings (Back)])([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4>
     5>Menu Picture place holder:
     6>
     7>[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Child_Protection.jpg)]][[BR]]
     8>
     9> here you can setup your key lock and child portection settings.
     10
     11[[br]]
     12
     13
     14 ||'''Pin Code Menu''' ||Select the pin code used in the menu.||
     15 ||'''Pin Code Channel:''' || select the pin code used to lock TV Channels.||
     16 ||'''Protect Channels:''' || Do you wish to enable the locking of protected channels.||
     17 ||'''Age Protect:''' || do you wish to protect channels based on age restrictions.||
     18 ||'''Protect Channel Freetime (min''' || After a specific time do you wish to re-enable the lock  on protected channels if it is currently beign displayed.||
     19 ||'''Protect menu:''' || Do you wish to place a lock on the menu of the reciever.||
     20 
     21 To __"Store"__ the settings Exit from the Child Protection Settings Menu by pressing __"OK"__ or press __"Exit"__ to cancel changes.
     22 
     23[[br]]
     24----
     25
     26 '''Coloured Button's Functions"
     27
     28 The __"Coloured Buttons"__ along the bottom of the display bring up additional menus and options with in the cchild protection settings menu
     29 please see below for more info on the functions of these buttons:.
     30 
     31 ||'''Red Button: (Menu Protect)''' ||pressing this button will bring up a list of menu items that a lock may be placed on to limit access to those areas, below is a list of all the menu items displayed in this menu.||
     32
     33 * Soft Cam Pannel
     34 * Records and EPG
     35 * Media Center
     36 * Media Player
     37 * Extentions
     38 * System
     39 * Settigs
     40 * Information
     41 * Standby/ Poweroff
     42 * Main Menu
     43 * Media Center
     44 * GUI Restart
     45 * Power Off
     46 * Network Restart
     47 * A/V Settings
     48 * Adjust
     49 * Skin
     50 * Plugins
     51 * Records
     52 * EPG Search
     53 * Common Interface
     54 * Smart Card Reader
     55 * Flash Update Online
     56 * Child Protection
     57 * Service
     58 * Sat Finder
     59 * Epg Short View
     60 * Single Epg
     61 * Multi Epg
     62 * Graphic Epg
     63 * EPG Search
     64 * Records
     65 * Plugins
     66 * Change Feed
     67 * TPK Upgrade (Online)
     68 * TPK Install (Online)
     69 * TPK Tmp (tmp)
     70 * TPK Media (media)
     71 * TPK (remove
     72 * Channel Service...
     73 * Common Interface
     74 * Smart Card Reader
     75 * Network
     76 * Harddisk
     77 * VFDisplay
     78 * Fancontrol
     79 * System Update
     80 * Backup
     81 * Settings Backup Restore
     82 * Receiver Unlock
     83 * A/V Settings
     84 * Language
     85 * Timezone
     86 * Red Button
     87 * Blue Button
     88 * Plugin Button
     89 * Adjust
     90 * Skin Adjust
     91 * Screensaver adjust
     92 * Timeshift Settings
     93 * Record Path
     94 * EPG Settings
     95 * Child Protection
     96 * Restore Default Settings
     97 * Video Settings
     98 * Channel Edit
     99 * MediaDB Settings
     100 * Autostart Settings
     101 * Overclocking Settings
     102 * Save Settings
     103 * Service
     104 * Newsletter
     105 * About
     106 * Streaming
     107 * Atemio (hotline)
     108 * Titan Changelog
     109 * GIT Changelog
     110 * System Info
     111 * Log
     112 * System_Status
     113 * Free Space
     114 * kernel
     115 * Mounts
     116 * Network
     117 * Ram
     118 * System Infos
     119 * Cpu
     120 * Memory
     121 * MTD
     122 * Module
     123 * Devices
     124 * Swap
     125 * Top
     126 * Prozesslist
     127 * USB
     128 * Flashupdate (online)
     129 * Flashupdate (tmp)
     130 * USBupdate (online)
     131 * USBupdate (tmp)
     132 * Power off
     133 * Standby
     134 * Restart
     135 * GUI Restart
     136 * Power Off Timer
     137 * Tuner Configuration
     138 * Automatic Search
     139 * Manual Search
     140 * Manual Search Cable
     141 * Manual Search Terrestrial
     142 * Rotor Settings
     143 * Sat Config
     144 * Sat Finder
     145 * Blind scan settings
     146 * Formatt HDD
     147 * Filesystem Check
     148 * Configure
     149 * Time to Sleep
     150 * Adapter Settings
     151 * WLAN Settings
  • wiki/pages/nl/Child-Safety

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2>----
     3>'''3.5.18.5 Child Safety''' [=#point3.5.18.5] ([wiki:Auto-Start-Settings#point3.5.18 Autostart Settings (Back)]) ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4>
     5>
     6>
     7>[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Autostart_Settings-child_safety.jpg)]][[br]]
     8>
     9Here you can adjust the lock settings on startup.
     10
     11[[br]]
     12
     13 ||'''Parental:''' ||Enable lock on startup.||
     14 ||'''Pin:''' ||Select the pin number for the lock on startup.||
     15 
     16 To __"Store"__ the settings Exit from the EPG Settings Menu by pressing __"OK"__ or press __"Exit"__ to cancel changes.
     17 
     18[[br]]
  • wiki/pages/nl/Common-Interface

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2>----
     3>'''3.5.2 Common Interface''' [=#point3.5.2] ([wiki:Interface-Operation#point3.5 System (Back)]) ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4>
     5>
     6>
     7>[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/system-Common_Interface.jpg)]][[BR]]
     8>
     9>here you can set up your installed cam devices.
     10
     11[[br]]
     12
     13 Picture:
     14 ||'''Module Type:''' ||Set the module service type (multiple/ Single Service).||
     15
     16  To __"Store"__ the settings Exit from the Common Interface Settings Menu by pressing __"OK"__ or press __"Exit"__ to cancel changes.
     17 
     18[[br]]
     19----
     20
     21 '''Coloured Button's Functions"
     22
     23 The __"Coloured Buttons"__ along the bottom of the display bring up additional menus and options with in the Commom Interface menu.
     24 please see below for more info on the functions of these buttons:.
     25 
     26 ||'''Red Button: (Reset)''' ||This will reset the selected Common Interface Module.||
     27 ||'''Green Button: (Menu)''' ||This will Bring up the advanced Common Interface menu.||
     28 ||'''Yellow Button: (CAID)''' ||???.||
     29 ||'''Blue Button: (Channel)''' ||Select the channels the selected CA Module will Decode.||
     30 ||'''Menu Button: (Setting)''' ||This will show the settings for the selected CA Module.||
     31
     32
  • wiki/pages/nl/Community

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2----
     3'''14 Community''' [=#point14] ([wiki:English-Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4----
     5
     6[[br]]
     7
     8The TitanNit project is supported 24 hours in the public forum.
     9
     10For help and support feel free to join us on our forum
     11
     12||= '''[http://www.aaf-digital.info/forum/forum.php AAF Digital Forum]''' =||
     13||= [[Image(http://www.aaf-digital.info/images/logo.jpg,400,link=http://www.aaf-digital.info/forum/forum.php)]] =||
     14
     15[[br]]
  • wiki/pages/nl/Configure

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2>----
     3>'''3.5.5.3 Hard Disk Configure''' [=#point3.5.5.3]  ([wiki:Hard-Disk#point3.5.5 hard disk (Back)])
     4>
     5>
     6>[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Configure.jpg)]][[br]]
     7>
     8Here you can configure your harddisk see below for more information.
     9Note that you must enable ([wiki:Adjust#point3.6.7 Expertmode]) to show all available configure options in this display.
     10[[br]]
     11
     12[[br]]
     13
     14 ||'''Use as recordings-device''' ||Prepair the storage device for use as a recording medium.||
     15 ||'''Remove recordings-device''' ||disable the use of the storage device as a recording medium.||
     16 ||'''Use as plugins-device''' ||Prepair the storage device for use as a plugins medium.||
     17 ||'''Remove extentions-device''' ||disable the use of the storage device as a extentions medium.||
     18 ||'''Use as swap-device''' ||Prepair the storage device for use as a swap medium.||
     19 ||'''Remove swap-device''' ||disable the use of the storage device as a swap medium.||
     20 ||'''Use as backup-device''' ||Prepair the storage device for use as a backup medium.||
     21 ||'''Remove backup-device''' ||disable the use of the storage device as a backup medium.||
     22
     23
     24
     25 
     26 To __"Store"__ the settings Exit from the EPG Settings Menu by pressing __"OK"__ or press __"Exit"__ to cancel changes.
     27 
     28
     29
     30[[br]]
  • wiki/pages/nl/Contact

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2----
     3'''15 Contact''' [=#point15] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4----
     5
     6Interested External Developers or testers can feel free to chat with us via Skype.
     7  • Skype Chat: "TitanNit Dev Chat"
     8  • Skype Contact: obiwan1976
     9
     10[[br]]
     11[[br]]
  • wiki/pages/nl/Create-Default-Favorites

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2>----
     3>'''3.5.1.8 Create Default Favorites[=#point3.5.1.8] ([wiki:Channel-Service#point3.5.1 Channel-Service (Back)]) ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4>
     5>
     6>[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Create-Default-Favorites.jpg)]][[br]]
     7>
     8By selecting this option it will setup the default german favourites lists.
     9
     10Please note that selecting this button will remove all the user pre programmed in favourites.
     11
     12in future it may be able to set up favourite lists from the satellites/ providers programed into the tuner.
     13
     14   
     15 To __"Store"__ the settings by pressing __"OK"__ or press __"Exit"__ to cancel changes.
     16
  • wiki/pages/nl/Create-Transponder-List

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2>----
     3>'''3.5.1.7 Create Transponder List''' [=#point3.5.1.7] ([wiki:Channel-Service#point3.5.1 Channel-Service (Back)]) ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4>
     5>
     6>[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Create-Transponder-List.jpg)]][[br]]
     7>
     8Here you can automatically set up transponders for various services from the TitanNit online repo this will save you from having to manually create these lists from your pc or from a satellite xml generator, this will greatly simpifly channel and tuner setup.
     9
     10please note that these lists may be out dated and not contain a complete list of transponders for every service.
     11
     12[[br]]
     13
     14 ||'''Create Transponder (Sat) ''' ||Downloads a list of current transponders from the online repo for all available satellites services. ||
     15 ||'''Create Transponder (Cable) ''' ||Downloads a list of current transponders from the online repo for all available cable services. ||
     16 ||'''Create Transponder (Terrestrial) ''' ||Downloads a list of current transponders from the online repo for all available Terrestrial services. ||
     17 ||'''Create Transponder (All) ''' ||Downloads a list of current transponders from the online repo for all available services. ||
     18
     19Please note that selecting one of the above options will remove all the transponders from the current channel data and may remove any custom satellite configs and tuner settings.
     20
     21in future it may merge the current programmed in user assigned transponders.
     22
     23A rescan will need to be preformed after preforming an option be sure to make a backup before proforming this action to be safe.
     24 
     25   
     26 To __"Store"__ the settings by pressing __"OK"__ or press __"Exit"__ to cancel changes.
     27
  • wiki/pages/nl/DYNDNS-Settings

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2>----
     3>'''3.5.4.7 DYNDNS Settings''' [=#point3.5.4.7] ([wiki:Network#point3.5.4 network (Back])
     4>
     5>
     6>[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/DYNDNS-Settings.jpg)]][[br]]
     7>
     8Here you can setup your DYNDNS interface.
     9
     10[[br]]
     11
     12 ||'''Start on Boot:''' ||Start the DYNDNS server on startup.||
     13 ||'''User:''' ||setup the username for DYNDNS.||
     14 ||'''Password:''' ||Set the password for DYNDNS.||
     15 ||'''DNS NAME:''' ||set the dns name.||
     16 ||'''DNS Syatem:''' ||???.||
     17 
     18 To __"Store"__ the settings Exit from the Settings Menu by pressing __"OK"__ or press __"Exit"__ to cancel changes.
     19 
     20[[br]]
     21----
     22
     23 '''Coloured Button's Functions"
     24
     25 The __"Coloured Buttons"__ along the bottom of the display bring up additional menus and options with in the epg settings menu.
     26 please see below for more info on the functions of these buttons:.
     27 
     28 ||'''Text Button: (Keyboard)''' ||This will will bring up editor to edit a value or text string.||
     29 ||'''Green Button: (Start)''' ||Start the DYNDNS server.||
     30 ||'''Yellow Button: (Stop)''' ||Stop the DYNDNS server.|| ||
  • wiki/pages/nl/Default-Autostart

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2>----
     3>'''3.5.18.1 Default Autostart''' [=#point3.5.18.1] ([wiki:Auto-Start-Settings#point3.5.18 Autostart Settings (Back)]) ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4>
     5>
     6>
     7>[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/DE/Autostart_Settings-default_Autostart.jpg)]][[br]]
     8>
     9Here you can check and adjust the startup settings.
     10
     11[[br]]
     12
     13 ||'''Bootstop:''' ||???.||
     14 ||'''Debug:''' ||Here you can set the debug mode and adjust the complexicity of the log output.||
     15 ||'''Show IP:''' ||Scan for a Media Highway version 2 EPG stream during  EPG scan.||
     16 ||'''Updatelist:''' ||??.||
     17 
     18 To __"Store"__ the settings Exit from this Menu by pressing __"OK"__ or press __"Exit"__ to cancel changes.
     19 
  • wiki/pages/nl/Development

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2----
     3'''11 Development''' [=#point11] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4----
     5
     6=== Plugins Building ===
     7
     8'''Preparation'''
     9
     10In the current tdt git http://gitorious.org/open-duckbox-project-sh4 you can now build TitanNit plugins.
     11I have installed 2 plugins that are intended to serve as an example. One can then download and unzip this locally and build your own plugins.
     12
     13With a fresh clone of the git
     14
     15{{{
     16make yaud-enigma2-nightly
     17}}}
     18
     19after it completes, then
     20
     21{{{
     22make titanium-plugins
     23}}}
     24
     25[[br]]
  • wiki/pages/nl/Devices

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2>----
     3>'''3.7.8.6.5 Devices''' [=#point3.7.8.6.5] ([wiki:System-Infos#point3.7.8.6 System Infos (Back])
     4>
     5>Menu Picture place holder:
     6>
     7>[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Devices.jpg)]][[br]]
     8>
     9Here you can view the detailed loaded devices info.
     10
     11[[br]]
     12
     13
     14[[br]]
  • wiki/pages/nl/Disclaimer

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2----
     3'''17 Generic Disclaimer''' [=#point17] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4----
     5
     6TitanNit is a Semi closed source setop box linux based operating system software. The services provided by AAF Digital including (including developer tools, resources, download areas, files, source code, product information, documentation, communication forums, bug tracker, wiki, internet, streaming, forum etc. all collectively called "services") that the TitanNit Project, its members, and websites provide are for the purpose of providing support to the community and aditional functionality from the original system software provided by the manufactures of the supported hardware.
     7The services provided bt the AAF digital team is provided “as is”, "with all faults", and "as available" basis, without warranty of any kind, either express or implied. Your use of these services is at your own risk. TitanNit disclaims all warranties.
     8 
     9TitanNit disclaims liability for any direct, indirect, incidental, special, consequential, exemplary, punitive or other damages, or lost profits, that may result directly or indirectly from the use of these services and any material that is downloaded or obtained through the use of these services.
     10 
     11This includes, without limitation, any damage to computer systems, hardware or software, loss of data, or any other performance failures, any errors, bugs, viruses or other defects that result from, or are associated with the use of these services.
     12 
     13None of the contributors, sponsors, administrators, or anyone else connected with TitanNit in any way whatsoever can be responsible for the appearance of any inaccurate or libelous information or for your use of the information contained in or linked from these services.
     14
     15AAF Digital reserve the right to to remove and add services as they see fit without warning.
     16
     17
     18 
     19'''No contract, limited license'''
     20 
     21
     22Please make sure that you understand that these services is being provided freely, and that no kind of agreement or contract is implied between the owners or users of these services, the owners of the servers upon which it is housed, the individual contributors to these services, any project administrators, sysops or anyone else who is in any way connected with the project subject to your claims against them directly. You are being granted a limited license to copy or install anything from this site; it does not create or imply any contractual or extracontractual liability on any of it's agents, members, organizers or other users. Neither is anyone responsible should someone change, edit, modify or remove any information contained with in these services.
     23
     24 
     25
     26'''Trademarks'''
     27
     28 
     29Any of the trademarks, service marks, collective marks, design rights or similar rights that are mentioned, used or cited in the services provided for TitanNit are the property of their respective owners. Their use in any "service" does not imply that you may use them for any other purpose other than for the same or a similar use as contemplated by the original authors concent.
     30the AAF Digital team will make due effort to outline the services that are provided by other's and give them credit where aplicable.
     31 
     32
     33'''Information and Content'''
     34
     35 
     36Publication of information found in any of the services provided for TitanNit may be in violation of the laws of the country or jurisdiction from where you are viewing this information. The servers providing these services are located in different locations of the world and is maintained in reference to the protections afforded under local and federal law in respect to their location. Laws in your country or jurisdiction may not protect or allow the same kinds of speech or distribution. the AAF digital team does not encourage the violation of any laws; and cannot be responsible for any violations of such laws, should you link to the domain of the websites of these services or use, reproduce, or republish the information contained therein.
     37
     38 
     39'''Final Remarks'''
     40
     41 
     42Enjoy TitanNit and the other services provided by AAF Digital and thanks for selecting us!
     43 
  • wiki/pages/nl/EPG-Search

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2>----
     3>'''3.1.4 EPG Search''' [=#point3.1.4] ([wiki:Interface-Operation#point3.1 Records and EPG(Back)]) ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4>
     5>
     6>[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Epg_Search.jpg)]][[BR]]
     7>
     8EPG Search is where you can search the EPG title, discription genra for specific keywords to search for programs to set up Recordings.
     9
     10[[br]]
     11
     12 '''Coloured and Extra Button's Functions"
     13
     14 The __"Coloured and Extra Buttons"__ along the bottom of the display bring up additional menus and options with in the Search EPG menu.
     15 please see below for more info on the functions of these buttons:.
     16 
     17 ||'''Red Button: (Timer)''' ||This will bring up the recording timer menu to set up a timer.||
     18 ||'''Green Button: (Title)''' ||This will search the EPG title string for text you specify and bring up a list of matches where you may press the red button to set up a timer.||
     19 ||'''Yellow Button: (Discription)''' ||This will search the EPG Discription string for text you specify and bring up a list of matches where you may press the red button to set up a timer.||
     20 ||'''Blue Button: (All)''' ||This will search all EPG string for text you specify and bring up a list of matches where you may press the red button to set up a timer.||
     21 ||'''Menu (Genre):''' ||This will search the EPG Genre string for text you specify and bring up a list of matches where you may press the red button to set up a timer.||
     22
     23For information on setting up a timer Recording using the red button see ([WikiStart#point103.10.6 Records]) for more info.
  • wiki/pages/nl/EPG-Settings

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2>----
     3>'''3.6.11 EPG Settings''' [=#point3.6.11] ([wiki:Interface-Operation#point3.6 Settings (Back)])([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4>
     5>Menu Picture place holder:
     6>
     7>[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/EPG_Settings.jpg)]][[BR]]
     8>
     9>Here you can change your epg settings.
     10
     11[[br]]
     12
     13 
     14 ||'''EPG Path''' ||Set to any Path you want where the EPG File should be stored (on Receivers with little Memory it is strongly recommended to extend it by using a USB Pen-Drive or Harddisk)||
     15 ||'''How Many Days:''' ||The Number of Days in Advance of the EPG to store (I recommend no higher than 8 Days)||
     16 ||'''Delete EPG after read:''' ||Do you want the EPG file to be deleted after being read.||
     17 ||'''EPG Save Mode:''' ||When should the EPG Data be stored to the storage medium. Caution: Should you not use a Pen Drive or Harddisk for EPG Storage set to Never, as Receivers with little Memory on Board tend to crash due to Insufficient free space.||
     18 ||'''Show EPG Screen (EPG Button):''' ||Which EPG format should be shown on EPG Key-press on the Remote.||
     19 ||'''EPG Free Space (kb):''' ||Total of minimal Free Memory that should be kept on the medium where the epg is stored to aviod free space errors.||
     20 ||'''EPG List Mode:''' ||What Channels should be scanned in the background (Only for twin Receivers) for EPG (scan)(whitelist) (scanlist and whitelist) (deactivate (disable scan)).||
     21 ||'''EPG Scan Time:''' ||Here you can set the time of the automatic EPG scan. The Scan will be performed every Day at that set time. Should the Receiver be in Deep Stand-by it will "wake up" aprox. 5 Minutes before the scan is due to start.||
     22 ||'''EPG Button in EPG:''' ||Behavior of the EPG Button during EPG display.||
     23 ||'''Grafic EPG Zoom:''' ||Sets the zoom level of the EPG to show more or less of a time span of the shown programs.||
     24 ||'''Grafic EPG Picons:''' ||Set to yes to use picons or the alternative Picon sets in the infobar and EPG stored in /var/media/autofs/sda1/swapextensions/usr/local/share/titan/picons/ directory.||
     25 ||'''Delete EPG Before Scan:''' ||Should the EPG be deleted before a the timed scan.||
     26 ||'''After EPG Scan:''' ||Behavior after the EPG scan is completed EPG scan: Nothing (Stand-By) or Switch Off (Deep Stand-By).||
     27 ||'''MHW EPG:''' ||Scan for a Media Highway EPG stream during EPG scan.||
     28 ||'''MHW2 EPG:''' ||Scan for a Media Highway version 2 EPG stream during  EPG scan.||
     29 ||'''OpenTV EPG:''' ||Scan for an OpenTV EPG stream during EPG scan.||
     30 
     31 To __"Store"__ the settings Exit from the EPG Settings Menu by pressing __"OK"__ or press __"Exit"__ to cancel changes.
     32 
     33[[br]]
     34----
     35
     36 '''Coloured Button's Functions"
     37
     38 The __"Coloured Buttons"__ along the bottom of the display bring up additional menus and options with in the epg settings menu.
     39 please see below for more info on the functions of these buttons:.
     40 
     41 ||'''Red Button: (EPG Reset)''' ||This will reset the saved epg removing all program data.||
     42 ||'''Green Button: (Edit)''' ||On a customisable item this will bring up editor to edit a value or text string.||
     43 ||'''Yellow Button: (Scanlist)''' ||Brings up the epg scan list and you may from there add aditional boquets to be scaned during an epg scan.||
     44 ||'''Blue Button: (log)''' ||This will show you the past scan log history for the epg.||
     45
  • wiki/pages/nl/EPG-Short-View

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2>----
     3>'''3.1.1 EPG Short View''' [=#point3.1.1] ([wiki:Interface-Operation#point3.1 Records and EPG(Back)]) ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4
     5>
     6>
     7>[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/EPG_Short_View.jpg)]][[BR]]
     8>
     9
     10EPG Short View is a small easy to read horozontal epg of the current displayed channel including the infomation on the program you may scroll using the direction arrows to a future time.
     11[[br]]
  • wiki/pages/nl/External-Software

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2----
     3'''9 External Software''' [=#point9] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4----
     5
     6External Software is a collection of tools to supplement TitanNit.
     7
     8This is a list of applications that can be use with or for to manipulate or control your Receiver.
     9[[br]]
     10Below is a list of external applications please select a link below for more information.
     11
     12
     13
     14{{{#!div style="width: 1100px; margin: auto"
     15 {{{#!table style="border: none"
     16  {{{#!td align=center valign=top style="border: none; font-size: 115%"
     17  {{{#!div style="float: left"
     18[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/Common/Icons/External-Software/TiMote.png,align=left,link=[wiki:External-Software-TiMote#point9.1 9.1 TiMote (Android)])]]
     19  }}}
     20  '''[wiki:External-Software-TiMote#point9.1 9.1 TiMote (Android)]'''[[br]]
     21  {{{#!div style="float: left
     22Timote is an andriod application for streaming and control of TitanNit
     23  }}}
     24  }}}
     25  {{{#!td align=center valign=top style="border: none; font-size: 115%"
     26  {{{#!div style="float: left"
     27[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/Common/Icons/External-Software/TiView.png,align=left,link=[wiki:External-Software-TiView#point9.2 9.2 TiView (PC)])]]
     28  }}}
     29  '''[wiki:External-Software-TiView#point9.2 9.2 TiView (PC)]'''[[br]]
     30  {{{#!div style="float: left
     31TiView is an PC application for streaming and control of TitanNit
     32  }}}
     33  }}}
     34  {{{#!td align=center valign=top style="border: none; font-size: 115%"
     35  {{{#!div style="float: left"
     36[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/Common/Icons/External-Software/SatChannelListEditor.png,align=left,link=[wiki:External-Software-SatChannelListEditor#point9.3 9.3 SatChannelListEditor])]]
     37  }}}
     38  '''[wiki:External-Software-SatChannelListEditor#point9.3 9.3 SatChannelListEditor]'''[[br]]
     39  {{{#!div style="float: left
     40SatChannelListEditor is an PC application for manipulation of your TitanNit channel data.
     41  }}}
     42  }}}
     43  |----
     44  {{{#!td align=center valign=top style="border: none; font-size: 115%"
     45  {{{#!div style="float: left"
     46[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/Common/Icons/External-Software/E2WebIFAPI.png,align=left,link=[wiki:External-Software-E2WebIfAPI#point9.4 9.4 E2WebIfAPI])]]
     47  }}}
     48  '''[wiki:External-Software-E2WebIfAPI#point9.4 9.4 E2WebIfAPI]'''[[br]]
     49  {{{#!div style="float: left
     50E2WebIfAPI is an console application to support the dreambox xml web interface commands.
     51  }}}
     52  }}}
     53  {{{#!td align=center valign=top style="border: none; font-size: 115%"
     54  {{{#!div style="float: left"
     55[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/Common/Icons/External-Software/TitanEditor.png,align=left,link=[wiki:External-Software-TitanEditor#point9.5 9.5 TitanEditor])]]
     56  }}}
     57  '''[wiki:External-Software-TitanEditor#point9.5 9.5 TitanEditor]'''[[br]]
     58  {{{#!div style="float: left
     59TitanEditor is an PC application for manipulation of dreambox channel data to work on of your TitanNit Receiver.
     60  }}}
     61  }}}
     62  {{{#!td align=center valign=top style="border: none; font-size: 115%"
     63  {{{#!div style="float: left"
     64[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/Common/Icons/External-Software/TitanNitLanguageEditor.png,align=left,link=[wiki:External-Software-TitanNitLanguageEditor#point9.6 9.6 TitanNitLanguageEditor])]]
     65  }}}
     66  '''[wiki:External-Software-TitanNitLanguageEditor#point9.6 9.6 TitanNitLanguageEditor]'''[[br]]
     67  {{{#!div style="float: left
     68TitanLanguageEditor is an PC application for editing GUI language translations.
     69  }}}
     70  }}}
     71}}}
     72}}}
  • wiki/pages/nl/External-Software-E2WebIfAPI

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2'''9.4 E2WebIfAPI''' [=#point9.4] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     3
     4
     5== Introduction ==
     6Enigma2 Web Interface ( WebIf ) API was defined for Dreambox .
     7It is a protocol that allows you to control a Dreambox via HTTP requests.
     8
     9Typical control tasks are :
     10
     11* Programming (timer) and playing back recordings
     12* Live streaming (TV and radio)
     13* EPG functions (display, search)
     14* Remote control (Remote Control)
     15
     16You can find a good overview of the E2WebIFAPI in the [http://dream.reichholf.net/wiki/Enigma2:WebInterface DreamboxWIKI].
     17
     18== Motivation ==
     19
     20For TitanNit the Android App [wiki:External-Software-TiMote#point109.1 9.1 TiMote] was developed. Anybody with an Android Smart-Phone or Tablet with this software installed can control their receiver or watch TV on the Android device. Isn't that cool?
     21
     22But owners of an iOS-device (i-Phone or i-Pad) are unlucky as there is no iOS TitanNit compatable web client such as TiMote. You can control your receiver via http protocol (same as Web Interface) but you wont be able to use all advantages like tiMote on an Android Platform.
     23
     24On the other hand iOS and Android Apps already exist for Dreambox receivers. These Apps are based on the Enigma2 protocol. Couldn't one just use that App on iOS instead of developing a new App?
     25
     26== The solution ==
     27TitanNit has its own protocol but is not compatible to the Enigma2 WebIf. Following a short analysis it was discovered that converting E2 requests to Titan didn't seem so difficult. Therefore, an E2 web server (e2webserv) was developed, which implements the Enigma2 WebIf. This server receives the E2 requests, delegates the calls to TitanNit web server and the responses is converted back into the XML format, which is expected from the E2 client.
     28
     29This way the TitanNit receiver is able to correspond to existing E2 - client software.
     30
     31
     32== Requirements ==
     33
     34* The Web server must be enabled on the receiver
     35* The E2webserv must be installed on the receiver
     36
     37== IOS Apps ==
     38
     39The following apps are installed on my iPad2:
     40* dreaMote
     41* DreaMote Lite
     42* e2RemoteHD
     43* Dreambox Live
     44
     45Should you not want to purchase any apps from the Apps-Store I can recommend dreaMote Lite .
     46
     47In addition to the app you need a player.
     48
     49I have tried the following players, which work well for me:
     50* Good Player
     51* BUZZ Player
     52* OPlayerHD Lite
     53* VLC Player
     54
     55VLC and OPlayerHD Lite are free.
     56
     57== XBMC ==
     58
     59If you are running the Media Center software [http://xbmc.org/ XBMC] or [http://xbmc4xbox.org.uk/ XBMC4XBOX], you can connect your Titan receiver via the Live-TV-Plugin VU+.
     60XBMC runs on Windows PCs aswell as Linux and is also available for Raspberry Pi and the Xbox.
     61
     62== VLC ==
     63Having installed the e2webserv you can enjoy Live-Streaming on your Windows or Linux PC using [http://www.videolan.org/vlc/ VLC] (no further software needed).
     64
     65You do not have to switch channels manually it all happens automatically. In order for this to take place you need an M3U playlist. You can easily generate the playlist by your Favourites and save to your PC. Having done so you only need to open the M3U list in VLC and select the desired channel.
     66
     67How do you export a particular favourites list into an M3U file?
     68
     69Enter the address in your Web browser.
     70
     71Example (favourite is "Polish"):
     72
     73[http://192.168.1.1:8080/web/services.m3u?bRef=Polish]
     74
     75Enter your receivers IP address and where names of Favourites have spaces within these spaces must be replaced with "%20".
     76
     77Example (favourite is "My TV" Receiver - IP: 192.168.0.10):
     78
     79[http://192.168.0.10:8080/web/services.m3u?bRef=Mein%20TV]
     80
     81Client Configuration == ==
     82Please configure the E2-clientas accordingly:
     83* IP address of the receiver
     84* Port: 8080
     85* Streaming Port: 8001
     86
     87Please note that SSL is not supported.
     88
     89Below you see an example configuration for dreaMote.
     90
     91[[Image(DreaMote.png,384px)]]
     92
     93== E2webserv.conf ==
     94
     95You must alter the server configuration manually. Using standard configured TitanNit no alterration on the e2webserv.conf should be neccessary.
     96
     97Should you have installed the plugin to Flash the configuration file '''e2webserv.conf''' lies in the directory '''/mnt/swapextensions/etc'''
     98
     99Here is the content:
     100{{{
     101# E2 web port
     102port = 8080
     103# E2 data port
     104data port = 8001
     105# Titan web port
     106titanium- port = 80
     107# Titan data port
     108titan data port = 22222
     109# Titan host (change it if e2webserv is not running locally on the receiver)
     110titan host = 127.0.0.1
     111# Automatic switching of channels
     112# It is useful if you do not want manually switch a channel on receiver with a single tuner.
     113# If it is set to false and you have a single tuner you can stream the only channels located
     114# On the same transponder as the current channel active on the receiver .
     115Autozap = true
     116# Log output file
     117logFile = /tmp/e2webserv.log
     118# Maximum log file size in KB. Set it to 0 (default 10KB) to disable logging (maximum allowed value is 1024).
     119# When the file limit is reached a backup of the current file is created .
     120# It Means maximally 2 x MaxLogSize KB will be used.
     121MaxLogSize = 10
     122# Thread pool size (1 through 8)
     123threadpool = 2
     124# Directory where the transponder and bouquet files are located.
     125# You do not need to Specify it, it will be Automatically Discovered .
     126# But if you you start e2webserv not on the receiver (but eg on your Linux server or Windows computer) then you
     127# Shoulderstand copy the settings (channel, transponder, provider and all bouquets file) and here Specify the location on the local computer .
     128titanDir = /mnt/settings
     129}}}
     130
     131== Links ==
     132
     133* Enigma2 Web API in [http://www.aaf-digital.info/forum/showthread.php?90948-Enigma2-Web-API-f % FCr - TitanNit AAF Forum]
     134* Sources on [https://github.com/gswiatek/e2api4titan GitHub]
     135[[br]]
     136[[br]]
  • wiki/pages/nl/External-Software-SatChannelListEditor

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2'''9.3 SatChannelListEditor''' [=#point9.3] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     3
     4This manual applies to version 5.4 of SatChannelListEditor (SCLE). In future releases,[[br]]
     5possibly new features will be added, making the screen shots of this program obsolete.
     6
     7== Requirements ==
     8SCLE has been programmed for the runtime environment " Microsoft. NET Framework ".[[br]]
     9Currently .NET Framework version 2.0 or higher is required.
     10
     11( also take a look at [http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/.NET_Framework Wikipedia article . NET Framework] )
     12
     13== Windows ==
     14* In  Windows XP .NET Framework version 2.0, 3.0 or 3.5 must be installed.[[br]]
     15(3.0 and 3.5 are extended versions include version 2.0)
     16* For Windows Vista and Windows 7 the .NET Framework librarys are implemented[[br]]
     17in the operating system and do not need to be installed seperately.
     18* In Windows 8 .NET Framework 3.5 must be installed. As Windows 8 by default,[[br]]
     19only includes .NET framework 4.5, which is not compatible with SCLE
     20== Linux ==
     21In Linux, the Mono framework is required (see [http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Mono_(software)Wikipedia article about Mono project]) .
     22[[BR]] You may have to install WinForms libraries manually with "apt -get install libmono- winforms * "
     23[[BR]] You may then run SCLE from the command line with the command "mono SatChannelListEditor.exe ".
     24
     25== Mac OS ==
     26In Mac OS , just like Linux, the Mono-Framework is required to to run SCLE.
     27
     28== The first startup ==
     29After the first startup of SCLE the language is set to English and the receiver[[br]]
     30model " UFS -821 " is selected. You now have to set the language and your[[br]]
     31Receiver model to suite your receiver.
     32
     33Select the receiver and its System you like to manage.
     34
     35== Setting the receiver model and type of operating system ==
     36Select the menu under " Options ", select " Settings" :
     37
     38[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/SCLE/3.png)]]
     39
     40Select Titan in the window that appears as the receiver you wish to connect to:
     41
     42[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/SCLE/4.png)]]
     43
     44After selecting the reciever type under the option " Titan " set the IP address of your Receiver, before[[br]]
     45you close the window confirm the settings by clicking the OK button.[[br]]
     46The other settings on this page should not be changed.
     47
     48[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/SCLE/5.png)]]
     49
     50== Download and upload the channel list ==
     51
     52After the Receiver model and the IP address have been set, you can fetch the channel[[br]]
     53list from your Receiver (Download) and after processing send it back to the Receiver (upload).
     54[[BR]] Use the Buttons in the Menubar of SCLE or in the Drop-down Menu:
     55
     56[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/SCLE/6.png)]]
     57
     58[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/SCLE/7.png)]]
     59
     60When you start an upload or download the program will automatically change to[[br]]
     61the message window where status messages are displayed for file transfer.
     62
     63== Edit the channel list ==
     64
     65== Favourites ==
     66
     67All TV and Radio channels are displayed in the tab "TV" and "Radio" in the main window[[br]]
     68of SCLE. Normally there are several hundreds or thousands of channels in this list.
     69[[BR]] To simplify navigation on your Receiver you may add the channels to more than one Favourites list.[[br]]
     70The Favourites also determine the channel number for easier and direct access with your remote control.
     71[[BR]] Create new favourites by clicking the right mouse button within the tree of favourites:
     72
     73[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/SCLE/8.png)]]
     74
     75After creating the new Favourites entry assign the desired Name:
     76
     77[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/SCLE/9.png)]]
     78
     79You may now add channels to your favourites by drag & drop of the channels[[br]]
     80onto the Favourites entry or by clicking the right mouse button on the desired channel[[br]]
     81and selecting Add to Favourites and selecting the Favourites Entry from the drop-down-menu:
     82
     83[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/SCLE/10.png)]]
     84
     85Once a channel has been added to the favourites, a channel number is assigned.[[br]]
     86The first channel in the first favourites is channel number 1:
     87
     88[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/SCLE/11.png)]]
     89
     90When a channel is assigned to more than one favourites list, it additionally[[br]]
     91obtains further channel numbers:
     92
     93[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/SCLE/12.png)]]
     94
     95=== EPG favourite "EPG scan " ===
     96
     97For TV channels there is a special favourite called "EPG scan".[[br]]
     98Copy all channels you want to be included for the timed EPG scan, all channels in this list[[br]]
     99will have their epg automatically scaned.
     100
     101[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/SCLE/13.png)]]
     102
     103=== Satellite ===
     104Creating and Editing Satellite entrys
     105Switch to the "Satellite" tab. After clicking the right mouse button the[[br]]
     106drop-down-menu is displayed, where you can create a new Satellite or edit an existing one.[[br]]
     107Double - clicking on an existing Satellite also opens this for editing.
     108
     109[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/SCLE/14.png)]]
     110
     111[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/SCLE/15.png)]]
     112
     113=== Creating and Editing Transponders ===
     114
     115Switch to the "Transponder" tab. After clicking the right mouse button the drop-down-menu[[br]]
     116is displayed, where you can create a new Transponder or edit an existing one.[[br]]
     117Double - clicking on an existing Transponder also opens this for editing.
     118
     119[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/SCLE/16.png)]]
     120
     121[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/SCLE/17.png)]]
     122
     123=== Creating and Editing Channels ===
     124Switch to the tab "TV" or "Radio". After clicking the right mouse button the drop-down-menu[[br]]
     125is displayed, where you can create a new channel or edit an existing one.[[br]]
     126Double - clicking on an existing channel also opens this for editing.
     127
     128[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/SCLE/18.png)]]
     129
     130[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/SCLE/19.png)]]
     131
     132=== Using receiver profiles ===
     133
     134If you have more than one Receiver, it is advisable to work with profiles.[[br]]
     135Go to the settings and enable the checkbox "Use Receiver Profiles":
     136
     137[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/SCLE/20.png)]]
     138
     139Enter a name for the profile, and click the "Save" button.[[br]]
     140The profile will be created with the current settings specified under the "Titan" tab.
     141[[BR]] To create a profile for a second titan receiver, switch to the "Titan" tab,[[br]]
     142enter the IP address of the second receiver, switch back to the "General" tab,[[br]]
     143enter a new profile name and click on "Save" once again.
     144
     145When you close the settings window by clicking the -OK-button- You will now[[br]]
     146discover the new selection menu where you may choose your Receiver profile.
     147
     148[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/SCLE/21.png)]]
  • wiki/pages/nl/External-Software-TiMote

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2----
     3'''9.1 TiMote''' [=#point9.1] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4----
     5
     6[[br]]
     7
     8Timote is a universal remote control for Linux-based receivers.
     9Currently (Atemio) TitanNit, Enigma2 and Neutrino are supported.
     10please note that screen shots were taken from TiMote version xxx future versions of TiMote could make these screenshots invalid.
     11
     12Features:
     13- Bouquets / Favorites
     14- Show EPG
     15- EPG search (*)
     16- Show the current station
     17- View recordings, stream and delete (*)
     18- Create, edit and delete timer
     19- Satfinder (*)
     20- Power Control
     21- Virtual Remote
     22- News
     23(*) Only Titannit/E2
     24
     25To stream an appropriate player, for example, MX Player, VPlayer or BSPlayer (lite) need to be installed.
     26If the app crashes, please activate the "send error report automatically" in the Settings. you can
     27thereby help improve the software and make troubleshooting easier crucial to the developer.
     28Comments, questions, suggestions or requests? Write me an email or post a comment on the app homepage!
     29appear
     30
     31[[br]]
     32
     33[[Image(http://www.android.com/images/brand/get_it_on_play_logo_large.png)]]
     34[[br]]
     35[https://play.google.com/store/apps/details?id=eu.azato.timote PlayStore]
     36
     37[[br]]
     38When you open up Timote You are presented with the main interface along the top of the display the radio buttons are used as the menu of Timote [[br]]
     39See below for more information.
     40
     41'''Main''' [[br]]
     42[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/TiMote/Main.png)]]
     43
     44Main contains a list of the main functions of timote:
     45
     46||'''([wiki:External-Software-TiMote-TV#point0 TV]) ''' ||This will bring up a list of Boquets on the reciever).||
     47||'''([wiki:External-Software-TiMote-On-air#point0 On-air]) ''' ||This will Bring up the information of the TV channel currently displaying on the Reciever||
     48||'''([wiki:External-Software-TiMote-Movies#point0 Movies]) ''' ||This will bring up the Movielist's stored on the reciever).||
     49||'''([wiki:External-Software-TiMote-Timer#point0 Timer]) ''' ||This will bring up a list of the current timer recordings on the reciever).||
     50||'''([wiki:External-Software-TiMote-EPG-Search#point0 EPG-Search]) ''' ||This will bring up a a search page to search the EPG for a specific keyword).||
     51
     52[[br]]
     53
     54'''Misc''' [[br]]
     55[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/TiMote/Misc.png)]]
     56
     57Misc contains a list of other functions of TiMote:
     58
     59||'''([wiki:External-Software-TiMote-Signal-Finder#point0 Signal-Finder]) ''' ||This will bring up the signal info's of the current displayed channel.||
     60||'''([wiki:External-Software-TiMote-Screenshot#point9.1.1 Screenshot]) ''' ||This will take a screen shot of the TV Display||
     61||'''([wiki:External-Software-TiMote-Remote#point9.1.2 Remote]) ''' ||This will bring up the on screen remote).||
     62||'''([wiki:External-Software-TiMote-Message#point9.1.3 Message]) ''' ||This can be used to send messages to the TV display).||
     63||'''([wiki:External-Software-TiMote-Power-Menu#point9.1.4 Power Menu]) ''' ||This will bring up the power control menu
     64||'''([wiki:External-Software-TiMote-RGui#point9.1.5 RGui]) ''' ||This will start the RGui engine||
     65||'''([wiki:External-Software-TiMote-LCD-Mode#point9.1.6 LCD Mode]) ''' ||???||
     66||'''([wiki:External-Software-TiMote-Power-About#point09.1.7 Power About]) ''' ||This will bring up information on the developers of TiMote).||
     67
     68'''Profiles''' [[br]]
     69[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/TiMote/Profile.png)]]
     70
     71Profiles is a list of receiver profiles with the ability to select and control multiple receivers.
     72you may create a new profile using the add button at the top of the display.
     73
     74
     75----
     76Temp data to move to Individual pages
     77
     78
     79[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/TiMote/Stream.png)]]
     80
     81[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/TiMote/Boquet.png)]]
     82
     83
     84
  • wiki/pages/nl/External-Software-TiView

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2----
     3'''9.2 TiView''' [=#point9.2] ([wiki:English-Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4----
     5TiView is a Windows 32bit application, that will run on a Windows 32/64bit system.[[br]]
     6The Tool uses the HTTP-RAW-Api of TitanNit.[[br]]
     7[[br]]
     8''Highlights of TiView''
     9
     10- *Output of the TV-Screen on your PC
     11- *Watch recordings on your PC
     12- *PiP function for 2 simultaneous TV-Stream or recording viewing on your PC
     13- *Proxy function for external access from a remote TiView and streaming a recoded stream
     14- Management of timers for recordings
     15- Infobar with progress bar for the actual program
     16- Picon-view in the Infobar(Enabled by adding the picons into the folder /picons in TiView)
     17- Channel EPG
     18- Multi EPG
     19- Grafical Multi EPG
     20- EPG Search
     21- Overview of recordings
     22- Manage profiles should one have more than one Receiver
     23- Signal-Monitor
     24- Send Messages to your Receiver
     25- OSD-Screenshot
     26'''*For Playback on your PC you need a compatable media player the 32bit version 2.x of VLC Player .'''[[br]]
     27(Alternativly you can copy libvlc.dll, libvlccore.dll and the Plugins folder from VLC into the TiView folder)
  • wiki/pages/nl/External-Software-TitanEditor

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2'''9.5 TitanEditor''' [=#point19.5] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     3
     4Titan editor is a simple channel list editor that is able to convert enigma channel data to be able to operate[[br]]
     5on a titan based receiver. It is also able to convert the filename from enigma 2 picons to the titan format.
     6
     7This software is still beta status but the basic functions are working, there has been posts noted on the AAF Forum that[[br]]
     8converting picons in some instances comit an unhandled exception error causing the program to exit.
     9 
     10- convert E2 channel list's incl. bouquets (this will not work 100% for some channels)
     11 - edit/delete and add Titan channels
     12 - convert E2 picons to Titan picons
     13 - manage bouquets
     14
     15The current version of TitanEditor is version 0.15 and it may be downloaded from here [http://www.aaf-digital.info/forum/showthread.php?78014-TitanEditor-V0-15&p=802005&viewfull=1#post802005 titanEditor]
     16
     17 
  • wiki/pages/nl/External-Software-TitanMote

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2----
     3'''9.1 TitanMote''' [=#point9.7] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4----
     5
     6[[br]]
     7
     8Titanmote is a universal remote control for Linux-based receivers.
     9Currently there is a little information we can provide reguarding this from the developer jagabongo.
     10
     11''Words from the developer:''
     12----
     13I'm currently working on an iOS app for TitanNit . For this I would need a few beta testers .
     14
     15The app will cost money later when development is finished and will be able to be purchased from the store, I will not releace it free because I have specially bought for this purpose a developer account and will take many hours of development, I also do not want the app to feature advertising.
     16
     17requirements:
     18 - IPhone or iPad with iOS > = 7.0
     19 - A bit of technical understanding
     20 - Lust for testing
     21
     22A few recent screenshots :
     23 https://www.dropbox.com/sh/armi0c3q72i350h/vm3szZDzvK
     24
     25
     26So in Version 1 I should be able to:
     27 
     28 - Browse by bouquets / channel lists + See Epg info and switch Channels.
     29 - Add timers on an event with the epg data.
     30 - List all timer
     31 - Delete Timer
     32 - easy remote copy with touch buttons
     33 - 2 profiles
     34 - Everywhere pull to refresh .
     35 - [ EDIT] Forgot , it will be multilingual or , DE, FR, IT and rest English. But languages ​​are all relatively retrofitted without hazzle
     36
     37Future features:
     38
     39 - User: Password WebIf Auth . ( hopefully not often used)
     40
     41 - Https support. ( Was I already am going to test with self-signed stuff but totally in the pants ... )
     42
     43 - The stream to an iOS device is just not as easy as on Android that is why they first moved to the rear.
     44 
     45
     46BETA testing runs like this:
     47 
     48 * 1 You send with your UUID ( google iOS Device UUID to find out )
     49
     50 * 2 Your you created an account at https://build.phonegap.com ( Free is sufficient).
     51
     52 * 3 You share me with your UUID and email phonegap.build accounts.
     53 
     54When that's done you can you log on your mobile Safari in build.phonegap.com and always install it there through the browser to the latest build. (OTA Installation).
     55 
     56This is perfectly legal and possible even without jailbreak.
     57
     58
     59if you are intreseed in becomming a better tester please leave a message in the [[http://www.aaf-digital.info/forum/showthread.php?100699-iOS-TitanNit-iOS-App-!-titanMote-!-Tester-gesucht!&p=974748#post974748 | forum]].
  • wiki/pages/nl/External-Software-TitanNitLanguageEditor

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2----
     3'''9.6 TitanNit Language Editor''' [=#point9.6] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4----
     5
     6The TitanNit Language Editor tool is used to provide translations files for devs to implement translations into the TitanNit gui.
     7
     8=== Made by Karlo ===
     9
     10German and English languages have been made and have been merged into svn.
     11To support future languages you can use this program to download  the language base files from the svn for conversion it supports UTF-8 so special
     12chracters from various languages can be implemented.
     13
     14Please check the [[http://www.aaf-digital.info/forum/showthread.php?98565-TitanNitLanguageEditor forum Link | main thread]] for the latest version, or the [#point9.6.7 Changelog]:
     15
     16
     17
     18This program requires microsoft visual basic runtime files to operate.
     19
     20Once you have made a Translation you may upload the translation po files to the aaf forum for implementation into TitanNit.
     21
     22If you think you can help with a translation please do so at the end of this page there is information on ([#point9.6.5 Submission]).
     23
     24
     25[[br]]
     26
     27----
     28'''Features''' ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     29----
     30 
     31* load po file from svn __"File/ Open Source (svn)"__
     32* Import po file from svn or local as source __"File/ Import Titan.po"__
     33* open local file as target__"File/ Open target (local)"__
     34* save target file __"File/ Save Target"__
     35* save target file as titan.po __"File/ Save titan.po"__
     36* export msg string for external use __"File/ Export msgstr as Titan.po"__
     37* Build reciever translation file __"File/ Build Titan.mo"__
     38* export sourcefile to target __"Edit/ target.po -> target"__
     39* view source target differences __"Edit/ diff target - titan.po"__
     40
     41[[br]]
     42
     43----
     44'''Functions'''  ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     45----
     46
     47''Select an item to view more info:''
     48
     49* ([#point9.6.1 Loading a translation from svn])
     50* ([#point9.6.2 Loading a Translation from a local directory])
     51* ([#point9.6.3 Import Translation from svn or local (Source/ Target Mode)])
     52* ([#point9.6.4 Edit Translation])
     53* ([#point9.6.5 Submission])
     54* ([#point9.6.6 Local Testing])
     55
     56
     57
     58----
     59'''Loading a translation from svn''' [=#point9.6.1] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     60----
     61
     62To load a translation from the server SVN repo select the translation file from the menu: [[br]]
     63
     64[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/TLE/open_server.jpg)]] [[br]]
     65
     66it will then start downloading from the internet.[[br]]
     67
     68[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/TLE/loading_server.jpg)]] [[br]]
     69
     70[[br]]
     71([#point9.6 Top of Page])
     72[[br]]
     73
     74----
     75'''Loading a Translation from a local directory''' [=#point9.6.2] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     76----
     77
     78To load a translation from the local directory select the translation file from the menu: [[br]]
     79
     80[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/TLE/open_local.jpg)]] [[br]]
     81
     82[[br]]
     83([#point9.6 Top of Page])
     84[[br]]
     85
     86----
     87'''Import Translation from svn or local (Source/ Target Mode)'''[=#point9.6.3] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     88----
     89
     90To import a translation from svn or the local directory select the translation file from the menu: [[br]]
     91Note: for this to work a source file must be loaded first [[br]]
     92
     93[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/TLE/import_file.jpg)]] [[br]]
     94
     95[[br]]
     96
     97you will then be dispalyed with this view to view the two po files along side each other:
     98
     99[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/TLE/import_list_view.jpg)]] [[br]]
     100
     101[[br]]
     102
     103you can then select __"Edit/ diff target - titan.po"__ to view the source and target differences.
     104
     105[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/TLE/diff_target.jpg)]] [[br]]
     106
     107[[br]]
     108
     109you can also automatically merge the source files to the target file  by selecting __"Edit/ target.po -> target"__
     110
     111[[br]]
     112([#point9.6 Top of Page])
     113[[br]]
     114
     115----
     116'''Edit Translation''' [=#point9.6.4] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     117----
     118
     119
     120Now that it is loaded you may edit the msgid strings to suit your language and upload to the aaf forum.
     121you may use the buttons on the lower taskbar to search for strings you wish to edit.[[br]]
     122
     123[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/TLE/edit.jpg)]]
     124
     125[[br]]
     126([#point9.6 Top of Page])
     127[[br]]
     128 
     129----
     130'''Submission'''[=#point9.6.5]  ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     131----
     132
     133If you could submit your completed translation file into the thread below for comitting by the devs into svn.
     134 
     135please note that some translations may no be able to be imported into some receivers due to memory constarints.
     136
     137[http://www.aaf-digital.info/forum/showthread.php?98565-TitanNitLanguageEditor forum Link]
     138
     139[[br]]
     140([#point9.6 Top of Page])
     141[[br]]
     142
     143----
     144'''Local Testing''' [=#point9.6.6] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     145----
     146
     147If you wish to install your modified language files into your reciever for testing you can so by exporting you file an a titan.mo file you can do this by selecting __"File/ Build Titan.mo"__ for this to work you need to install some aditional components  in to the program directory.
     148
     149To do this create a folder in the program directory called __"gettext"__ and extract the below files into that directory:
     150
     151
     152[http://ftp.informatik.rwth-aachen.de/ftp/pub/gnu/gettext/gettext-runtime-0.13.1.bin.woe32.zip gettext-runtime] [[br]]
     153[http://ftp.informatik.rwth-aachen.de/ftp/pub/gnu/libiconv/libiconv-1.9.1.bin.woe32.zip libiconv] [[br]]
     154[http://ftp.informatik.rwth-aachen.de/ftp/pub/gnu/gettext/gettext-tools-0.13.1.bin.woe32.zip gettext-tools] [[br]]
     155
     156Once you have exported your titan.mo file you may ftp or manually copy it onto your Receiver to test it.
     157
     158The file needs to go into the directory and a reboot neede to be proformed afterwards:  '''/var/usr/local/share/titan/po/__??__/LC_MESSAGES/titan.mo)''' where __??__ is the language file you are editing.
     159
     160''Note: if you have trouble exporting the translation to a mo file place the program directory on the root of your harddisk it can some times fail if the program it too deep in the file system''
     161
     162[[br]]
     163([#point9.6 Top of Page])
     164[[br]]
     165
     166----
     167'''Change log''' [=#point9.6.7] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     168----
     169
     170
     171
     172Version 0.7 :
     173 * Loading and saving is now Uniformly in UTF- 8! Now special characters can be used from other languages.
     174 
     175Version 0.8 :
     176 
     177 * minor changes
     178 * 'Build titan.mo ' for more infomation see ([#point9.6.6 Local Testing])
     179
     180Version 0.8.1 :
     181 * 1 Column now displays the line number of the msgid
     182 * 'Build titan.mo ' - in case of error in a makeMo.cmd Prog -Dir is created at the (click ) is probably better to see what 's going on
     183 * 'Edit / show only diff ' - same entries appear at msgid <> titan.po from
     184
     185Version 0.8.2 :
     186 * Fixed tooltip error
     187
     188Version 0.9.0 :
     189 * Fixed Error 13 - Thanks to Channel beta-testing
     190 * 'Import 2 po file ' to load an alternate po -files
     191 * ' titan.po -> Target' copied now empty fields Double entry copied by msgid
     192
     193version 0.9.1 :
     194 * svn version is displayed and saved as ' .... po.55555.svn '
     195 * thus can also be compared with an old ( stored ) version
     196
     197[[br]]
     198([#point9.6 Top of Page])
     199[[br]]
  • wiki/pages/nl/File-Browser

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2>----
     3>'''3.2.5 File Browser''' [=#point3.2.5] ([wiki:Interface-Operation#point3.2 Media Center (Back)])([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4>
     5>Menu Picture place holder:
     6>
     7>[[Image(http://sbnc.dyndns.tv/trac/export/26462/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/file_manager.jpg)]][[br]]
     8>
     9>Here you can browse files from any source available from your decoder (local or network)
     10> you may do such things as copy delete and move.
     11
     12
     13[[br]]
  • wiki/pages/nl/Filesystem-Check

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2>----
     3>'''3.5.5.1 File system Check''' [=#point3.5.5.1] ([WikiStart#point3.5 System (Back])
     4>
     5>
     6>[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Filesystem-Check.jpg)]][[br]]
     7>
     8Here you can format your harddisk select an item and follow the onscreen prompts.
     9
     10[[br]]
     11
     12
     13 
     14
     15[[BR]]
  • wiki/pages/nl/Format-Hdd

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2>----
     3>'''3.5.5 Hard Disk''' [=#point3.5.5] ([wiki:Interface-Operation#point3.5 system (Back)])
     4>
     5>
     6>[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Format-Hdd.jpg)]][[br]]
     7>
     8Here you can format your harddisk select an item and follow the onscreen prompts.
     9Note that you must enable ([wiki:Adjust#point3.6.7 Expertmode]) to show all available format options in this display.
     10
     11[[br]]
     12
     13
     14 
     15
     16[[BR]]
  • wiki/pages/nl/Free-Space

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2>----
     3>'''3.7.8.2 Free Space''' [=#point3.7.8.2] ([wiki:System-Info#point3.7.8 System Info (Back])
     4>
     5>
     6>[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Free-Space.jpg)]][[br]]
     7>
     8Here you can view the free space of all the file systems acessable from the decoder.
     9
     10[[br]]
     11
     12
     13[[br]]
  • wiki/pages/nl/Functions

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2
     3----
     4'''2 Interface Elements''' [=#point2] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     5----
     6[[br]]
     7This section will show the functions and controls of the various elements in the gui within TitanNit and discriptions to the various
     8items and their functions aswell as helpfull information and tricks to get the most possible experience with your Receiver.
     9
     10Note: pictures in this area only apply to the default skin used in Titan.
     11If you do not see a specific menu item on the display please select the default skin from the menu as follows all the functions displayed below are implemented in all skins but some elements may be omitted from the display in some skins:
     12
     13 Press the __"Menu"__ button and select __"Settings"__ scroll down to __"Skin"__ and select the __"Default"__ Skin from the menu.
     14 The decoder will then reboot with the new selected __Default__ skin.
     15
     16----
     17{{{#!div style="width: 1100px; margin: auto"
     18 {{{#!table style="border: none"
     19  {{{#!td align=center valign=top style="border: none; font-size: 115%"
     20  {{{#!div style="float: left"
     21[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/Common/Icons/Functions/Infobar.png,align=left,link=[#point2.1])]]
     22  }}}
     23  '''[#point2.1 infobar]'''[[br]]
     24  {{{#!div style="float: left
     25Default display when pressing the __Info__ button while watching TV.
     26  }}}
     27  }}}
     28  {{{#!td align=center valign=top style="border: none; font-size: 115%"
     29  {{{#!div style="float: left"
     30[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/Common/Icons/Functions/playback_infobar.png,align=left,link=[wiki:History#point2.2 TitanNit Info])]]
     31  }}}
     32  '''[#point2.2 Playback infobar]'''[[br]]
     33  {{{#!div style="float: left
     34Default display when pressing the __Info__ button while watching A recording or Media using the default player.
     35  }}}
     36  }}}
     37  {{{#!td align=center valign=top style="border: none; font-size: 115%"
     38  {{{#!div style="float: left"
     39[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/Common/Icons/Functions/AudioTracks_infobar.png,align=left,link=[#point2.3])]]
     40  }}}
     41  '''[#point2.3 Audiotracks infobar]'''[[br]]
     42  {{{#!div style="float: left
     43Default display when pressing the __Audio__ button while watching TV, A recording or Media using the default player.
     44  }}}
     45  }}}
     46  |----
     47  {{{#!td align=center valign=top style="border: none; font-size: 115%"
     48  {{{#!div style="float: left"
     49[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/Common/Icons/Functions/Channel History.png,align=left,link=[#point2.4])]]
     50  }}}
     51  '''[#point2.4 Channel History]'''[[br]]
     52  {{{#!div style="float: left
     53Default display when pressing the __Recall__ button while watching A recording or Media using the default player.
     54  }}}
     55  }}}
     56  {{{#!td align=center valign=top style="border: none; font-size: 115%"
     57  {{{#!div style="float: left"
     58[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/Common/Icons/Functions/Sleep_Timer.png,align=left,link=[#point2.5])]]
     59  }}}
     60  '''[#point2.5 Sleep Timer]'''[[br]]
     61  {{{#!div style="float: left
     62Default display when pressing the __Sleep_ button while the decoder is in operation.
     63  }}}
     64  }}}
     65  {{{#!td align=center valign=top style="border: none; font-size: 115%"
     66  {{{#!div style="float: left"
     67[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/Common/Icons/Functions/Subtitle.png,align=left,link=[#point2.6])]]
     68  }}}
     69  '''[#point2.6  Subtitle]'''[[br]]
     70  {{{#!div style="float: left
     71Default display when pressing the __Subtitle__ button while watching TV, A recording or Media using the default player.
     72  }}}
     73  }}}
     74  |----
     75  {{{#!td align=center valign=top style="border: none; font-size: 115%"
     76  {{{#!div style="float: left"
     77[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/Common/Icons/Functions/EPG.png,align=left,link=[#point2.7])]]
     78  }}}
     79  '''[#point2.7 EPG]'''[[br]]
     80 {{{#!div style="float: left
     81Default display when pressing the __EPG__ button while watching TV.
     82  }}}
     83  }}}
     84  {{{#!td align=center valign=top style="border: none; font-size: 115%"
     85  {{{#!div style="float: left"
     86[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/Common/Icons/Functions/program_info.png,align=left,link=[#point2.8])]]
     87  }}}
     88  '''[#point2.8 Program Info]'''[[br]]
     89   {{{#!div style="float: left
     90Default display when pressing the __Info__ button while viewing the EPG.
     91  }}}
     92  }}}
     93  {{{#!td align=center valign=top style="border: none; font-size: 115%"
     94  {{{#!div style="float: left"
     95[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/Common/Icons/Functions/player.png,align=left,link=[#point2.9])]]
     96  }}}
     97  '''[#point2.9 Player]'''[[br]]
     98  {{{#!div style="float: left
     99Default display when pressing the __Play_ button.
     100  }}}
     101  }}}
     102  |----
     103  {{{#!td align=center valign=top style="border: none; font-size: 115%"
     104  {{{#!div style="float: left"
     105[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/Common/Icons/Functions/favourite.png,align=left,link=[#point2.10])]]
     106  }}}
     107  '''[#point2.10 Favourite]'''[[br]]
     108  {{{#!div style="float: left
     109Default display when pressing the __FAV__ button.
     110  }}}
     111  }}}
     112  {{{#!td align=center valign=top style="border: none; font-size: 115%"
     113  {{{#!div style="float: left"
     114[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/Common/Icons/Functions/record.png,align=left,link=[#point2.11])]]
     115  }}}
     116  '''[#point2.11 Record]'''[[br]]
     117  {{{#!div style="float: left
     118Default display when pressing the __REC__ button while watching TV.
     119  }}}
     120  }}}
     121
     122
     123 }}}
     124}}}
     125----
     126[[BR]]
     127
     128
     129
     130
     131
     132'''Infobar''' [=#point2.1] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     133
     134[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Info-OSD.jpg)]] [[br]]
     135This overlay display shows when you press the __"INFO"__ button when viewing a tv channel. [[br]]
     136It shows actual and next program information
     137
     138[[br]]
     139'''Playback Infobar''' [=#point2.2] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     140
     141[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Playback-OSD.jpg)]] [[br]]
     142This overlay shows when you press the __"INFO"__ button when playing back a program or time shift is in operation. [[br]]
     143It shows a list of the available buttons to use when in playbac/timeshift to do various things.
     144
     145[[br]]
     146'''Audio Track''' [=#point2.3] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     147
     148[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Audio-OSD.jpg)]] [[br]]
     149This overlay shows when you press the __"AUDIO""__ button when viewing a tv channel. [[br]]
     150It allows you to adjust the audio track on the current stream if an alternative audio source exists.
     151
     152[[br]]
     153'''History''' [=#point2.4] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     154
     155[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/History-OSD.jpg)]] [[br]]
     156This overlay shows when you press the __"RECALL"__ button when viewing a tv channel. [[br]]
     157It allows you to recall the past viewed channels for fast zapping between them.
     158
     159[[br]]
     160'''Sleep Timer''' [=#point2.5] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     161
     162[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Sleep-OSD.jpg)]] [[br]]
     163This overlay shows when you press the __"SLEEP"__ button. [[br]]
     164It allows you to set the shutdown timer to automatically shutdown the receiver.
     165
     166[[br]]
     167'''Subtitle''' [=#point2.6] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     168
     169[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Subtitle-OSD.jpg)]] [[br]]
     170This overlay shows when you press the __"SUBTITLE"__ button. [[br]]
     171It allows you to select/enable a subtitle during playback.
     172
     173[[br]]
     174'''EPG''' [=#point2.7] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     175
     176[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/EPG-OSD.jpg)]] [[br]]
     177This overlay shows when you press the __"EPG"__ button. [[br]]
     178It shows a list of the program information from here you can setup a timer or search the EPG.
     179
     180[[br]]
     181'''Program Info''' [=#point2.8] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     182
     183[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Program-Info-OSD.jpg)]] [[br]]
     184This Overlay shows when you press the __"INFO"__ button when in the EPG display. [[br]]
     185This shows the current selected program information.
     186
     187[[br]]
     188'''Player''' [=#point2.9] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     189
     190[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Internal-Player-OSD.jpg)]] [[br]]
     191This overlay shows when you press the __"PLAY"__ button. [[br]]
     192It allows you to select a movie or recording to play it also has a basic file manager.
     193
     194[[br]]
     195'''Favourite''' [=#point2.10] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     196
     197[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Favourite-OSD.jpg)]] [[br]]
     198This overlay shows when you press the __"FAV"__ button. [[br]]
     199It allows you to brouse through your favourits lists.
     200
     201[[br]]
     202'''Record''' [=#point2.11] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     203
     204[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Record-OSD.jpg)]] [[br]]
     205This overlay shows when you press the __"RECORD"__ button. [[br]]
     206It allows you to set the record function on the current tv channel.
     207
     208[[br]]
  • wiki/pages/nl/Git-Changelog

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2>----
     3>'''3.7.7 GIT Changelog''' [=#point3.7.7] ([wiki:Interface-Operation#point3.7 Information (Back)])([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4>
     5>Menu Picture place holder:
     6>
     7>[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Git_Changelog.jpg)]][[BR]]
     8>
     9> here you can git information.
     10
     11[[br]]
     12
  • wiki/pages/nl/Graphic-EPG

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2>----
     3>'''3.1.3 Graphic EPG''' [=#point3.1.3] ([wiki:Interface-Operation#point3.1 Records and EPG(Back)]) ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4>
     5>Menu Picture place holder:
     6>
     7>[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Graphical_EPG.jpg)]][[BR]]
     8>
     9Graphic EPG is a multi channel graphical EPG.
     10
     11
     12[[br]]
     13
     14 '''Coloured and Extra Button's Functions"
     15
     16 The __"Coloured and Extra Buttons"__ along the bottom of the display bring up additional menus and options with in the Single EPG menu.
     17 please see below for more info on the functions of these buttons:.
     18 
     19 ||'''Red Button: (Timer)''' ||This will bring up the recording timer menu to set up a timer.||
     20 ||'''0 key (EPG Search):''' ||This will search the EPG for text you specify and bring up a list of matches where you may press the red button to set up a timer.||
     21 ||'''FAV Button: (Favourite)''' ||This will bring up Favourite Boquet menu to select the EPG you would like to display.||
     22 ||'''Info Button: (Info)''' ||This will bring up the selected program's EPG info string.||
     23 
     24
     25
     26For information on setting up a timer Recording using the red button see ([WikiStart#point103.10.6 Records]) for more info.
     27For information on setting proforming an EPG search using the 0 Key see ([WikiStart#point103.10.5 EPG Search]) for more info.
  • wiki/pages/nl/HTTP-Settings

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2>----
     3>'''3.5.4.6 HTTP Settings''' [=#point3.5.4.6] ([wiki:Interface-Operation#point3.5.1 network (Back])
     4>
     5>
     6>[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/HTTP-Settings.jpg)]][[br]]
     7>
     8Here you can setup your HTTP interface.
     9
     10[[br]]
     11
     12||'''Start HTTPD:''' ||Start the webserver.||
     13 ||'''User:''' ||Sets the zoom level of the EPG to show more or less of a time span of the shown programs.||
     14 ||'''Password:''' ||Set to yes to use picons or the alternative Picon sets in the infobar and EPG stored in /var/media/autofs/sda1/swapextensions/usr/local/share/titan/picons/ directory.||
     15 ||'''HTTPD Port:''' ||Should the EPG be deleted before a the timed scan.||
     16 ||'''IP for Stream:''' ||Behavior after the EPG scan is completed EPG scan: Nothing (Stand-By) or Switch Off (Deep Stand-By).||
     17 ||'''Stream Port:''' ||Scan for a Media Highway EPG stream during EPG scan.||
     18 ||'''Start RGUID:''' ||Scan for a Media Highway version 2 EPG stream during  EPG scan.||
     19 ||'''RGUID Port''' ||Scan for an OpenTV EPG stream during EPG scan.||
     20 
     21 To __"Store"__ the settings Exit from the EPG Settings Menu by pressing __"OK"__ or press __"Exit"__ to cancel changes.
     22 
     23[[br]]
     24----
     25
     26 '''Coloured Button's Functions"
     27
     28 The __"Coloured Buttons"__ along the bottom of the display bring up additional menus and options with in the epg settings menu.
     29 please see below for more info on the functions of these buttons:.
     30 
     31 ||'''Text Button: (Keyboard)''' ||This will bring up the onscreen keyboard to edit the currently selected test string.||
     32
     33
  • wiki/pages/nl/Hard-Disk

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2>----
     3>'''3.5.5 Hard Disk''' [=#point3.5.5] ([wiki:Interface-Operation#point3.5 System (Back)]) ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4>
     5>Menu Picture place holder:
     6>
     7>[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/system-Hard_Disk.jpg)]][[BR]]
     8>
     9Here you can configure your harddisk.[[BR]]
     10please select a menu item for more information.
     11[[br]]
     12
     13 * ([wiki:Format-Hdd#point3.5.5.1 Format HDD])
     14 * ([wiki:Filesystem-Check#point3.5.5.2 Filesystem Check])
     15 * ([wiki:Configure#point3.5.5.3 Configure])
     16 * ([wiki:Time-to-sleep#point3.5.5.4 Time to sleep])
     17
     18[[BR]]
  • wiki/pages/nl/History

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2----
     3'''1 TitanNit Info Contents ''' [=#point1] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4----
     5[[br]]
     6This section conatins information on TitanNit and frequently asked questions about it.
     7Please choose an item below to find more information.
     8
     9You may select a skip to a specific setup topic or scroll down to read the complete guide.
     10
     11{{{#!div style="width: 1100px; margin: auto"
     12 {{{#!table style="border: none"
     13  {{{#!td align=center valign=top style="border: none; font-size: 115%"
     14  {{{#!div style="float: left"
     15[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/Common/Icons/History/About.png,align=left,link=[#point1.1])]]
     16  }}}
     17  '''([#point1.1 About])'''[[br]]
     18  {{{#!div style="float: left
     19click here to find info about TitanNit
     20  }}}
     21  }}}
     22  {{{#!td align=center valign=top style="border: none; font-size: 115%"
     23  {{{#!div style="float: left"
     24[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/Common/Icons/History/History.png,align=left,link=[#point1.2])]]
     25  }}}
     26  '''([#point1.2 History])'''[[br]]
     27  {{{#!div style="float: left
     28click here to find info on the beginnings of TitanNit
     29  }}}
     30  }}}
     31  {{{#!td align=center valign=top style="border: none; font-size: 115%"
     32  {{{#!div style="float: left"
     33[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/Common/Icons/History/Features.png,align=left,link=[#point1.3])]]
     34  }}}
     35  '''([#point1.3 Features])'''[[br]]
     36  {{{#!div style="float: left
     37click here to find info on the various features of TitanNit
     38  }}}
     39  }}}
     40}}}
     41}}}
     42
     43{{{#!div style="width: 1100px; margin: auto"
     44 {{{#!table style="border: none"
     45  {{{#!td align=center valign=top style="border: none; font-size: 115%"
     46  {{{#!div style="float: left"
     47[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/Common/Icons/History/Frequnetly_Asked_Questions.png,align=left,link=[#point1.4])]]
     48  }}}
     49  '''([#point1.4 Frequently Asked Questions])'''[[br]]
     50  {{{#!div style="float: left
     51Apendixcies/ references [[br]]to other setup related topics.
     52  }}}
     53  }}}
     54}}}
     55}}}
     56[[br]]
     57[[br]]
     58
     59----
     60'''1 About''' [=#point1.1] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     61----
     62[[br]]
     63TitanNit is a semi closed source replacement operating system for kathrein and Atemio/Atevio digital set top receivers.
     64It has come about  as the users/devs wanted something better than was currently available.
     65TitanNit is spawned from other projects and is developed by users come devs so it is easy of use but yet still remains powerfull and configurable and feature packed.[[br]]
     66[[br]]
     67[[br]]
     68
     69----
     70'''1 History''' [=#point1.2] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     71----
     72[[br]]
     73 * Everything started in April 2011. For almost three weeks our Developer Nit secretly worked on the foundation of Titan. After the presentation by Nit Obi and the rest of the team came on board. Everybody was surprised by the rapid development of the Titan Project.
     74 * From the beginning the development and source of Titan was nonpublic, as it was not to be foreseen in which direction the development would go.
     75 * After a development period of 6 months our hardware manufacturer Atemio declared interest in the project. Looking back at Years of support through Atemio with the Enigma2 Software, Atemio was given main priority for Titan project.
     76 * A six-months agreement with Atemio was signed in December 2011.
     77 * Due to the good cooperation the agreement was extended and is still in force.
     78 * The basic idea for this project originated for various reasons:
     79  * due to the missing Python Chip and low CPU speed the sh4 receivers have always had problems with Enigma2.
     80  * the constant improvement and expansion of Enigma2 and the TDT Git was comprehensive and time-consuming.
     81  * the alternative Neutrino GIT at that time was not layed out to support twin tuner Receivers.
     82  * Nit then decided to combine both, the Enigma2 and the Neutrino, to a new Gui which implemented all advantages of both systems.
     83  * Neutrinos main advantage has always been its speed
     84  * Enigma2s advantage was the ease of integration and expansion with skins and extensions
     85  * These two systems combined into one new system was the basic idea of Titan.
     86[[br]]
     87[[br]]
     88
     89----
     90'''2 Features''' [=#point1.3] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     91----
     92[[br]]
     93'' Highlights of TitanNit ''
     94
     95     - Powerful Linux operating system
     96     - Fast boot
     97         - About 1 second from standby mode
     98         - About 25 seconds from the deep standby mode
     99     - Fast channel switching times (less than 1 second)
     100     - Different menu interfaces (skins) including customization options
     101     - Many options to customize the system to your needs
     102     - Backup / Restore function
     103     - Organized Favourites and Channel listings and the direct list of following Programs. 
     104     - Multi-Tuner
     105     - Plug-in management
     106     - Supports many media formats
     107     - Wide range of plugins
     108     - PC programs to personalize and convert the channel list
     109     - Screen saver in radio mode
     110     - Remote control buttons freely assignable
     111     - Online update of the firmware with the ability to retain settings
     112     - Low memory consumption
     113     - 24 hour Forum Support
     114     - Growing Community
     115     - Web Interface
     116     - Android app "timote"
     117     - Windows App "tiView"
     118     - Bouquets Editor "SatchannelListEditor"
     119[[br]]
     120
     121
     122----
     123'''Frequently Asked Questions''' [=#point1.4] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     124----
     125[[br]]
     126
     127'''What is Titan?'''[[br]]TitanNit is a semi closed source replacement operating system for kathrein and Atemio/Atevio digital set top receivers designed to completly replace the factory software.
     128[[br]]
     129
     130'''What can Titan do?'''[[br]]Titan was primarally designed to play/view and record live tv services from tresterial, cable and satellite, it can also be used to play/view the most popular video, audio, and picture formats, and many more lesser-known formats, including:
     131 Video - DVD-Video, VCD/SVCD, MPEG-1/2/4, DivX, XviD, Matroska
     132Audio - MP3, AAC.
     133Picture - JPG, GIF, PNG.
     134
     135
     136These can all be played directly from the hard-drive or from a computer over a local network (LAN) internet IPTV services and media streams hosted by the [[wiki:Plugins-Player#point10.11 TiThek]] plugin.
     137
     138 TitanNit can play DVD-Video movies (with and without menus) from ISO/IMG images and even ZIP/RAR-archives with the use of the [[wiki:Plugins-Player#point10.11 dvd-player plugin]].
     139 TitanNit has a simple user interface that's pleasant and easy to use.
     140
     141All these features enable your device to function as a full multimedia entertainment system for your tv for the whole family to enjoy.
     142[[br]]
     143[[br]]
     144
     145'''What features does TitanNit have?'''[[br]]See the complete list of supported features in the [[wiki:Versions#point6 software versions changelog]] for information of the offically supported features.
     146[[br]]
     147[[br]]
     148 
     149'''Where can I suggest/request a new feature or function to be implemented into TitanNit?'''[[br]]You can log a NEW feature/function request in our tracker. Just make sure that you first remember to search for existing "Feature Requests" before logging a new request/ticket! (see [wiki:Troubleshooting#point12.1 12.1 Bug Reporting] for information on submitting a ticket).
     150
     151You may also post a copy of your suggestion in the feature-suggestion section of our [http://www.aaf-digital.info/forum/forum.php AAF Digital Forum] if you want it open for discussion,
     152Please respect that your request only counts as a suggestion, there' s no guarantee that it will implemented soon or ever.
     153
     154Almost all users think their own ideas is the most important, and a very common comment is: "if you only add these features then TitanNit will be perfect for me".
     155
     156You could try bribing the devs with elaborate gifts :-) flattery will get you every where and agorant requests will most likely get your posts deleted or get you banned from the forum please follow the rules of the forum [http://www.aaf-digital.info/ here].
     157[[br]]
     158[[br]]
     159 
     160'''When will this and that feature or function be supported by TitanNit?'''[[br]]TitanNit development is driven by the tasks that are important to the individual developers and to the hardware sponsors Atemio, if you have a funky idea or feature you wish implemented submit a request ticket (see [wiki:Troubleshooting#point12.1 12.1 Bug Reporting], but make an extensive search of the forum and tickets before requesting it as it has probally been sugested before.
     161[[br]]
     162[[br]]
     163
     164'''Is TitanNit, or the AAFTeam affiliated with Fortis, katherin or ..... or the hardware manufacturer of my Reciever?'''[[br]]No, TitanNit and its members are not in any way affiliated with the manufactures in any way. TitanNit is a third party operating system designed to replace the manufactures original operating system.
     165[[br]]
     166[[br]]
     167
     168'''Will the instalation of Titan Void my Warranty?'''[[br]]Yes probally but this software is tested to ensure it won't dammage your reciever and can be reverted at any time to a factory condition. please see [wiki:Supported-Receivers#point7 Supported Receivers] for a list of suspected supported receivers, If you have successfully installed TitanNit on your Receiver please inform an admin member so this list can be updated and verified.
     169
     170If the factory software was so feature packed and bugless there would be no need for software like TitanNit but sadly this is a world where software is driven by sales and purchases by the big players who request features, but TitanNit is a little different it was started just because the users/ devs wanted something better than what was handed to them by the manufacturer.
     171[[br]]
     172[[br]]
     173
     174'''Why is TitanNit Not available for my receiver model XXX?'''[[br]]TitanNit is funded by Atemio who supplys hardware to the devs in return for developing software for use on these devices.
     175In future TitanNit may be available for your receiver as support in increaced, at this time Titan in in development for the Broadcom Mips Archeture for the upcomming release of the Atemio 5200 which will be the first non SH4 based reciever supported by TitanNit.
     176[[br]]
     177[[br]]
     178
     179'''How do I ...'''[[br]] I don't know I suggest you read the [wiki:Quick-Start-Guide#point0 Quick Start Guide], manual, check the rest of the wiki or proform a [http://www.aaf-digital.info/forum/search.php?search_type=1 search] on the forum, as it has most likely been asked before and you will find the answer, as a last resort post a question on the [http://www.aaf-digital.info/forum/forum.php AAF Digital Forum].
     180[[br]]
     181[[br]]
     182
     183'''Where should I put videos/music and pictures so that Titan can read it?''' [[br]]Anywhere you like. TitanNit can read off the local harddisk,usb sticks, or from network sources. Simply press "Add a Source" using the network Browser and browse away.
     184>[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Network-Browser.jpg, 25%)]][[br]]
     185[[br]]
     186[[br]]
     187
     188'''What is the default username and password to the built-in FTP server and telnet server?'''Both the default password and the user name is “root” (in lower case) as with many linux instalations.
     189[[br]]
     190[[br]]
     191
     192'''Can I watch recordings from my decoder when on holiday?'''[[br]]yes you can you will need to set up either a static ip on your home network or set up a dynadns server, from there you can log onto the web interface and use video lan to watch tv or your recordings.
     193[[br]]
     194[[br]]
     195
     196'''Can I thank and or Chat the TitanNit team?''[[br]]Yes sure you can jump on the [[http://www.aaf-digital.info/forum/ AAFforum]]  and leave a post and or stop by [wiki:Contact#point15 Skype] and request a invite the majority of us speak german, some of us speak english also.
     197
     198'''Do you accept donations?'''[[br]] the team is currently fully funded and no donations are nesessary but if you have some device that may be of use with titan feel free to contact us.
     199
     200'''How come the Wiki does not show how to operate feature or function.....?'''[[br]]Titan Is in development and is updated almost daily some features plugins or informations have yet to be merged in, this forum is open to editing by the community feel free to log in and add said feature's informatation to the wiki.
     201[[br]]
     202[[br]]
     203
     204([#point1 Top of Page])
     205 
     206 
     207
     208
  • wiki/pages/nl/Installation-Recovery

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2----
     3'''8 Installation and Recovery Contents''' [=#point8] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4----
     5This section contains information on installation and removal of TitanNit from your receiver
     6{{{#!div style="width: 1100px; margin: auto"
     7 {{{#!table style="border: none"
     8  {{{#!td align=center valign=top style="border: none; font-size: 115%"
     9  {{{#!div style="float: left"
     10[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/Common/Icons/Receiver_logo/Atemio.png, 60px,align=left,link=http://www.atemio.de Atemio homepage)]]
     11  }}}
     12  '''SH4 Atemio'''[[br]]
     13  {{{#!div style="float: left
     14 [http://www.atemio.de Atemio homepage]
     15 * [wiki:Installation-Recovery-SH4-Atemio#point8.000 Contents]
     16 * [wiki:Installation-Recovery-SH4-Atemio#point8.001 Atemio510]
     17 * [wiki:Installation-Recovery-SH4-Atemio#point8.002 Atemio520]
     18 * [wiki:Installation-Recovery-SH4-Atemio#point8.003 Atemio530]
     19 * [wiki:Installation-Recovery-SH4-Atemio#point8.004 Atemio7600]
     20 * [wiki:Installation-Recovery-SH4-Atemio#point8.005 Atemio700]
     21 * [wiki:Installation-Recovery-SH4-Atemio#point8.006 Atemio7000]
     22  }}}
     23  }}}
     24  {{{#!td align=center valign=top style="border: none; font-size: 115%"
     25  {{{#!div style="float: left"
     26[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/Common/Icons/Receiver_logo/Fortis.png, 60px,align=left,link=http://www.fortis.co.kr Fortis homepage)]]
     27  }}}
     28  '''SH4 Fortis'''[[br]]
     29   {{{#!div style="float: left
     30 [http://www.fortis.co.kr Fortis homepage]
     31 * [wiki:Installation-Recovery-SH4-Fortis#point8.010 Contents]
     32 * [wiki:Installation-Recovery-SH4-Fortis#point8.011 Fortis Clone]
     33 * [wiki:Installation-Recovery-SH4-Fortis#point8.012 Bootloader Installation]
     34 * [wiki:Installation-Recovery-SH4-Fortis#point8.013 Fortis FS-9000]
     35 * [wiki:Installation-Recovery-SH4-Fortis#point8.014 Fortis FS-9200]
     36 * [wiki:Installation-Recovery-SH4-Fortis#point8.015 Fortis HS-9510]
     37 * [wiki:Installation-Recovery-SH4-Fortis#point8.016 Fortis HX-8200]
     38 * [wiki:Installation-Recovery-SH4-Fortis#point8.017 Fortis HS-7810]
     39  }}}
     40  }}}
     41 {{{#!td align=center valign=top style="border: none; font-size: 115%"
     42  {{{#!div style="float: left"
     43[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/Common/Icons/Receiver_logo/homecast.png, 60px,align=left,link=http://www.myhomecast.nl Homecast homepage)]]
     44  }}}
     45  '''SH4 Homecast'''[[br]]
     46 {{{#!div style="float: left
     47 [http://www.myhomecast.nl Homecast homepage]
     48 * [wiki:Installation-Recovery-SH4-Homecast#point8.020 Contents]
     49 * [wiki:Installation-Recovery-SH4-Homecast#point8.021 Homecast Pro]
     50  }}}
     51  }}}
     52  |----
     53  {{{#!td align=center valign=top style="border: none; font-size: 115%"
     54  {{{#!div style="float: left"
     55[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/Common/Icons/Receiver_logo/IPBox.png, 60px,align=left,link=http://www.abipbox.com/ AB IPBox homepage)]]
     56  }}}
     57  '''SH4 IPBox'''[[br]]
     58  {{{#!div style="float: left
     59 [http://www.abipbox.com/ AB IPBox homepage]
     60 * [wiki:Installation-Recovery-SH4-IPBox#point8.030 Contents]
     61 * [wiki:Installation-Recovery-SH4-IPBox#point8.031 Ipbox91]
     62 * [wiki:Installation-Recovery-SH4-IPBox#point8.032 Ipbox900]
     63 * [wiki:Installation-Recovery-SH4-IPBox#point8.033 Ipbox910]
     64 * [wiki:Installation-Recovery-SH4-IPBox#point8.034 Ipbox9000]
     65  }}}
     66  }}}
     67  {{{#!td align=center valign=top style="border: none; font-size: 115%"
     68  {{{#!div style="float: left"
     69[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/Common/Icons/Receiver_logo/kathrein.png, 60px,align=left,link=http://www.kathrein-gmbh.at kathrein homepage)]]
     70  }}}
     71  '''SH4 Katherin'''[[br]]
     72  {{{#!div style="float: left
     73 [http://www.kathrein-gmbh.at kathrein homepage]
     74 * [wiki:Installation-Recovery-SH4-Katherin#point8.040 Contents]
     75 * [wiki:Installation-Recovery-SH4-Katherin#point8.041 Ufs910]
     76 * [wiki:Installation-Recovery-SH4-Katherin#point8.042 Ufs912]
     77 * [wiki:Installation-Recovery-SH4-Katherin#point8.043 Ufs913]
     78 * [wiki:Installation-Recovery-SH4-Katherin#point8.044 Ufs922]
     79 * [wiki:Installation-Recovery-SH4-Katherin#point8.045 Ufc960]
     80  }}}
     81  }}}
     82  {{{#!td align=center valign=top style="border: none; font-size: 115%"
     83  {{{#!div style="float: left"
     84[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/Common/Icons/Receiver_logo/Spark.png, 60px,align=left,link=http://www.spark-tv.com Spark homepage)]]
     85  }}}
     86  '''SH4 Spark'''[[br]]
     87  {{{#!div style="float: left
     88 [http://www.spark-tv.com Spark homepage]
     89 * [wiki:Installation-Recovery-SH4-Spark#point8.050 Contents]
     90 * [wiki:Installation-Recovery-SH4-Spark#point8.051 Spark7111]
     91 * [wiki:Installation-Recovery-SH4-Spark#point8.052 Spark7162]
     92  }}}
     93  }}}
     94  |----
     95 {{{#!td align=center valign=top style="border: none; font-size: 115%"
     96  {{{#!div style="float: left"
     97[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/Common/Icons/Receiver_logo/Atemio.png, 60px,align=left,link=http://www.atemio.de Atemio homepage)]]
     98  }}}
     99  '''Mips Atemio'''[[br]]
     100  {{{#!div style="float: left
     101 [http://www.atemio.de Atemio homepage]
     102 * [wiki:Installation-Recovery-Mips-Atemio#point8.060 Contents]
     103 * [wiki:Installation-Recovery-Mips-Atemio#point8.061 Atemio5000 AKA Nemesis]
     104 * [wiki:Installation-Recovery-Mips-Atemio#point8.062 Atemio5200]
     105 * [wiki:Installation-Recovery-Mips-Atemio#point8.063 Atemio6000]
     106 * [wiki:Installation-Recovery-Mips-Atemio#point8.064 Atemio6100]
     107 * [wiki:Installation-Recovery-Mips-Atemio#point8.065 Atemio6200]
     108  }}}
     109  }}}
     110  {{{#!td align=center valign=top style="border: none; font-size: 115%"
     111  {{{#!div style="float: left"
     112[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/Common/Icons/Receiver_logo/beyonwiz.png, 60px,align=left,link=http://www.beyonwiz.com.au Beyonwiz homepage)]]
     113  }}}
     114  '''Mips Beyonwiz'''[[br]]
     115 {{{#!div style="float: left
     116 [http://www.beyonwiz.com.au Beyonwiz homepage]
     117
     118 * [wiki:Installation-Recovery-Mips-Beyonwiz#point8.070 Contents]
     119 * [wiki:Installation-Recovery-Mips-Beyonwiz#point8.071 BeyonwizT4]
     120  }}}
     121  }}}
     122  {{{#!td align=center valign=top style="border: none; font-size: 115%"
     123  {{{#!div style="float: left"
     124[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/Common/Icons/Receiver_logo/Goldern_Interstar.png, 60px,align=left,link=http://www.golden-interstar.pl Golden Interstar homepage)]]
     125  }}}
     126  '''Mips Golden Interstar'''[[br]]
     127  {{{#!div style="float: left
     128 [http://www.golden-interstar.pl Golden Interstar homepage]
     129 * [wiki:Installation-Recovery-Mips-Golden-Interstar#point8.080 Contents]
     130 * [wiki:Installation-Recovery-Mips-Golden-Interstar#point8.081 Xpeedlx1/2]
     131 * [wiki:Installation-Recovery-Mips-Golden-Interstar#point8.082 Xpeedlx3]
     132  }}}
     133  }}}
     134  |----
     135  {{{#!td align=center valign=top style="border: none; font-size: 115%"
     136  {{{#!div style="float: left"
     137[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/Common/Icons/Receiver_logo/Miraclebox.png, 60px,align=left,link=http://www.miraclebox.se miraclebox homepage)]]
     138  }}}
     139  '''Mips Miraclebox[[br]]
     140  {{{#!div style="float: left
     141 [http://www.miraclebox.se Miraclebox homepage]
     142 * [wiki:Installation-Recovery-Mips-Miraclebox#point8.090 Contents]
     143 * [wiki:Installation-Recovery-Mips-Miraclebox#point8.091 MBUltra]
     144 * [wiki:Installation-Recovery-Mips-Miraclebox#point8.092 MBMini]
     145}}}
     146}}}
     147  {{{#!td align=center valign=top style="border: none; font-size: 115%"
     148  {{{#!div style="float: left"
     149[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/Common/Icons/Receiver_logo/Sezam.png, 60px,align=left,link=http://www.sezam-club.ru/ homepage)]]
     150  }}}
     151  '''Mips Sezam'''[[br]]
     152 {{{#!div style="float: left
     153 [http://www.sezam-club.ru/ Mips Sezam homepage]
     154 * [wiki:Installation-Recovery-Mips-Sezam#point8.100 Contents]
     155 * [wiki:Installation-Recovery-Mips-Sezam#point8.101 Sezam-Marvel]
     156 * [wiki:Installation-Recovery-Mips-Sezam#point8.102 Sezam-1000HD]
     157  }}}
     158  }}}
     159}}}
     160}}}
     161
     162
     163----   
     164'''8.113 IRD Download Locations''' [=#point8.113] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main Page]) 
     165----
     166* [wiki:Manufactures#point13 13 Manufactures] - [http://atemio.de/index.php/software-updates Stable Images][[br]] 
     167* [wiki:Community#point14 14 Community] - [http://www.aaf-digital.info/forum/downloads.php?do=cat&id=2 Stable Images] [http://www.aaf-digital.info/forum/pages.php?pageid=12 Nightly Images][[br]] 
     168
     169  '''[wiki:Remote-Device-Control#point4.6 4.6 Bootloader sh4 Boxen]'''[[br]]
     170* [http://sbnc.dyndns.tv/trac/wiki/en/Remote-Device-Control#point4.6  iboot sh4 loader flashing and recovery ][[br]] 
     171 
     172[[br]] 
     173[#point8 Top of Page] 
     174[[br]]
     175
     176
     177
     178
     179
  • wiki/pages/nl/Installation-Recovery-Mips-Atemio

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2----
     3'''8.061 Mips Atemio''' [=#point8.061] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4----
     5
     6manufacturer blurb.....
     7
     8
     9
     10
     11
     12----
     13'''8.061 Atemio-Nemesis''' [=#point8.061] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     14----
     15'' How do I install an Atemio 5000 Update UBI image? ''
     16 * Visit the Atemio homepage or the AAF digital forum and download the latest TitanNit firmware . ([#point8.15 IRD Download Locations])
     17 * Extract the zip file
     18 * Now copy the unzipped IRD firmware file to a formatted FAT32 USB stick.
     19    Note: After unpacking two subfolders atemio/5x00 will be created . The USB stick should not be formatted with windows. Use a separate program, such as the " HP USB Disk Storage Format Tool" (freeware program).
     20     Furthermore, we recommend a cheap USB stick with a small storage capacity as well as read and write speed.
     21 * Turn off the Receiver and disconnect all USB devices.
     22 * Connect the USB stick with the IRD file to your Receiver
     23 * Switch on ( mains plug ) and press the CH + on the unit (1 button from the right ) until the Vfd ( LCD Display) displayes " Flashing ...".
     24   then the installation begins, Only then release the button.
     25    Note: If installation does not start , use a different USB stick.
     26 * After successfully installing the receiver will reboot and the installed image should start-up
     27[[br]]
     28[#point8 Top of Page]
     29[[br]]
     30----
     31'''8.062 Atemio5200''' [=#point8.062] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     32----
     33'' How do I install an Atemio 5200 Update UBI image? ''
     34 * Visit the Atemio homepage or the AAF digital forum and download the latest TitanNit firmware . ([#point8.15 IRD Download Locations])
     35 * Extract the zip file
     36 * Now copy the unzipped IRD firmware file to a formatted FAT32 USB stick.
     37    Note: After unpacking two subfolders atemio/5x00 will be created . The USB stick should not be formatted with windows. Use a separate program, such as the " HP USB Disk Storage Format Tool" (freeware program).
     38     Furthermore, we recommend a cheap USB stick with a small storage capacity as well as read and write speed.
     39 * Turn off the Receiver and disconnect all USB devices.
     40 * Connect the USB stick with the IRD file to your Receiver
     41 * Switch on ( mains plug ) and press the CH + on the unit (1 button from the right ) until the Vfd ( LCD Display) displayes " Flashing ...".
     42   then the installation begins, Only then release the button.
     43    Note: If installation does not start , use a different USB stick.
     44 * After successfully installing the receiver will reboot and the installed image should start-up
     45[[br]]
     46[#point8 Top of Page]
     47[[br]]
     48----
     49'''8.063 Atemio6000''' [=#point8.063] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     50----
     51'' How do I install an Atemio 6000 Update UBI image? ''
     52 * Visit the Atemio homepage or the AAF digital forum and download the latest TitanNit firmware . ([#point8.15 IRD Download Locations])
     53 * Extract the zip file
     54 * Now copy the unzipped IRD firmware file to a formatted FAT32 USB stick.
     55    Note: After unpacking two subfolders atemio/5x00 will be created . The USB stick should not be formatted with windows. Use a separate program, such as the " HP USB Disk Storage Format Tool" (freeware program).
     56     Furthermore, we recommend a cheap USB stick with a small storage capacity as well as read and write speed.
     57 * Turn off the Receiver and disconnect all USB devices.
     58 * Connect the USB stick with the IRD file to your Receiver
     59 * Switch on ( mains plug ) and press the CH + on the unit (1 button from the right ) until the Vfd ( LCD Display) displayes " Flashing ...".
     60   then the installation begins, Only then release the button.
     61    Note: If installation does not start , use a different USB stick.
     62 * After successfully installing the receiver will reboot and the installed image should start-up
     63[[br]]
     64[#point8 Top of Page]
     65[[br]]
     66----
     67'''8.064 Atemio6100''' [=#point8.064] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     68----
     69'' How do I install an Atemio 6100 Update UBI image? ''
     70 * Visit the Atemio homepage or the AAF digital forum and download the latest TitanNit firmware . ([#point8.15 IRD Download Locations])
     71 * Extract the zip file
     72 * Now copy the unzipped IRD firmware file to a formatted FAT32 USB stick.
     73    Note: After unpacking two subfolders atemio/5x00 will be created . The USB stick should not be formatted with windows. Use a separate program, such as the " HP USB Disk Storage Format Tool" (freeware program).
     74     Furthermore, we recommend a cheap USB stick with a small storage capacity as well as read and write speed.
     75 * Turn off the Receiver and disconnect all USB devices.
     76 * Connect the USB stick with the IRD file to your Receiver
     77 * Switch on ( mains plug ) and press the CH + on the unit (1 button from the right ) until the Vfd ( LCD Display) displayes " Flashing ...".
     78   then the installation begins, Only then release the button.
     79    Note: If installation does not start , use a different USB stick.
     80 * After successfully installing the receiver will reboot and the installed image should start-up
     81[[br]]
     82[#point8 Top of Page]
     83[[br]]
     84----
     85'''8.065 Atemio6200''' [=#point8.065] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     86----
     87'' How do I install an Atemio 6200 Update UBI image? ''
     88 * Visit the Atemio homepage or the AAF digital forum and download the latest TitanNit firmware . ([#point8.15 IRD Download Locations])
     89 * Extract the zip file
     90 * Now copy the unzipped IRD firmware file to a formatted FAT32 USB stick.
     91    Note: After unpacking two subfolders atemio/5x00 will be created . The USB stick should not be formatted with windows. Use a separate program, such as the " HP USB Disk Storage Format Tool" (freeware program).
     92     Furthermore, we recommend a cheap USB stick with a small storage capacity as well as read and write speed.
     93 * Turn off the Receiver and disconnect all USB devices.
     94 * Connect the USB stick with the IRD file to your Receiver
     95 * Switch on ( mains plug ) and press the CH + on the unit (1 button from the right ) until the Vfd ( LCD Display) displayes " Flashing ...".
     96   then the installation begins, Only then release the button.
     97    Note: If installation does not start , use a different USB stick.
     98 * After successfully installing the receiver will reboot and the installed image should start-up
     99[[br]]
     100[#point8 Top of Page]
     101[[br]]
  • wiki/pages/nl/Installation-Recovery-Mips-Beyonwiz

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2----
     3'''8.071 Beyonwiz''' [=#point8.070] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4----
     5
     6
     7manufacturer blurb.....
     8
     9
     10----
     11'''8.071 Beyonwiz T4''' [=#point8.071] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     12----
     13'' How do I install an Beyonwiz T4 Update UBI image? ''
     14 * Visit the Atemio homepage or the AAF digital forum and download the latest TitanNit firmware . ([#point8.15 IRD Download Locations])
     15 * Extract the zip file
     16 * Now copy the unzipped IRD firmware file to a formatted FAT32 USB stick.
     17    Note: After unpacking two subfolders atemio/5x00 will be created . The USB stick should not be formatted with windows. Use a separate program, such as the " HP USB Disk Storage Format Tool" (freeware program).
     18     Furthermore, we recommend a cheap USB stick with a small storage capacity as well as read and write speed.
     19 * Turn off the Receiver and disconnect all USB devices.
     20 * Connect the USB stick with the IRD file to your Receiver
     21 * Switch on ( mains plug ) and press the CH + on the unit (1 button from the right ) until the Vfd ( LCD Display) displayes " Flashing ...".
     22   then the installation begins, Only then release the button.
     23    Note: If installation does not start , use a different USB stick.
     24 * After successfully installing the receiver will reboot and the installed image should start-up
     25[[br]]
     26[#point8 Top of Page]
     27[[br]]
  • wiki/pages/nl/Installation-Recovery-Mips-Golden-Interstar

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2----
     3'''8.080 Goldern interstar Xpeedlx1/2''' [=#point8.080] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Inhaltsverzeichnis]) ([WikiStart#point0 Sprachauswahl])
     4----
     5
     6manufacturer blurb
     7
     8
     9
     10----
     11'''8.081 Goldern interstar Xpeedlx1/2''' [=#point8.081] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Inhaltsverzeichnis]) ([WikiStart#point0 Sprachauswahl])
     12----
     13''How do I install a Xpeedlx1/2 update image? ''
     14 * Visit the AAF digital forum and download the latest TitanNit firmware . ([#point8.33 IRD Download Locations])
     15 * Extract the zip file
     16 * Now copy the unzipped firmware folder "xpeedlx3"  to a formatted FAT32 USB stick.
     17    Note: The USB stick should not be formatted with windows, but a separate program, such as the " HP USB Disk Storage Format Tool" (freeware program). Furthermore, we recommend a cheap USB stick with a small storage capacity as well as read and write speed.
     18 * Turn off the Receiver and disconnect all USB devices.
     19 * Connect the USB stick with the update image file
     20 * Switch on (mains switch) and and when prompted on the vfd press the __Volume up__ button on the unit, then the installation begins. after the update starts release the __volume up__ button.
     21
     22Note: If installation does not start, use a different USB stick.
     23•After successfully installing the receiver will reboot and the installed image should start-up
     24[[br]]
     25[#point8 Top of Page]
     26[[br]]
     27----
     28'''8.082 goldern interstar Xpeedlx3''' [=#point8.082] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Inhaltsverzeichnis]) ([WikiStart#point0 Sprachauswahl])
     29----
     30''How do I install a Xpeedlx3 update image? ''
     31 * Visit the AAF digital forum and download the latest TitanNit firmware . ([#point8.33 IRD Download Locations])
     32 * Extract the zip file
     33 * Now copy the unzipped firmware folder "xpeedlx3" to a formatted FAT32 USB stick.
     34    Note: The USB stick should not be formatted with windows, but a separate program, such as the " HP USB Disk Storage Format Tool" (freeware program). Furthermore, we recommend a cheap USB stick with a small storage capacity as well as read and write speed.
     35 * Turn off the Receiver and disconnect all USB devices.
     36 * Connect the USB stick with the update image file
     37 * Switch on (mains switch) and and when prompted on the vfd press the __Volume up__ button on the unit, then the installation begins. after the update starts release the __volume up__ button.
     38
     39Note: If installation does not start, use a different USB stick.
     40•After successfully installing the receiver will reboot and the installed image should start-up
     41[[br]]
     42[#point8 Top of Page]
     43[[br]]
  • wiki/pages/nl/Installation-Recovery-Mips-Miraclebox

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2----
     3'''8.090 Miraclebox''' [=#point8.090] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4----
     5
     6manufacturer blurb......
     7
     8
     9
     10
     11
     12----
     13'''8.091 Miraclebox Ultra''' [=#point8.091] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     14----
     15'' How do I install an Miraclebox Ultra Update UBI image? ''
     16 * Visit the Atemio homepage or the AAF digital forum and download the latest TitanNit firmware . ([#point8.15 IRD Download Locations])
     17 * Extract the zip file
     18 * Now copy the unzipped IRD firmware file to a formatted FAT32 USB stick.
     19    Note: After unpacking two subfolders atemio/5x00 will be created . The USB stick should not be formatted with windows. Use a separate program, such as the " HP USB Disk Storage Format Tool" (freeware program).
     20     Furthermore, we recommend a cheap USB stick with a small storage capacity as well as read and write speed.
     21 * Turn off the Receiver and disconnect all USB devices.
     22 * Connect the USB stick with the IRD file to your Receiver
     23 * Switch on ( mains plug ) and press the CH + on the unit (1 button from the right ) until the Vfd ( LCD Display) displayes " Flashing ...".
     24   then the installation begins, Only then release the button.
     25    Note: If installation does not start , use a different USB stick.
     26 * After successfully installing the receiver will reboot and the installed image should start-up
     27[[br]]
     28[#point8 Top of Page]
     29[[br]]
     30----
     31'''8.092 Miraclebox Mini''' [=#point8.092] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     32----
     33'' How do I install an Miraclebox Mini Update UBI image? ''
     34 * Visit the Atemio homepage or the AAF digital forum and download the latest TitanNit firmware . ([#point8.15 IRD Download Locations])
     35 * Extract the zip file
     36 * Now copy the unzipped IRD firmware file to a formatted FAT32 USB stick.
     37    Note: After unpacking two subfolders atemio/5x00 will be created . The USB stick should not be formatted with windows. Use a separate program, such as the " HP USB Disk Storage Format Tool" (freeware program).
     38     Furthermore, we recommend a cheap USB stick with a small storage capacity as well as read and write speed.
     39 * Turn off the Receiver and disconnect all USB devices.
     40 * Connect the USB stick with the IRD file to your Receiver
     41 * Switch on ( mains plug ) and press the CH + on the unit (1 button from the right ) until the Vfd ( LCD Display) displayes " Flashing ...".
     42   then the installation begins, Only then release the button.
     43    Note: If installation does not start , use a different USB stick.
     44 * After successfully installing the receiver will reboot and the installed image should start-up
     45[[br]]
     46[#point8 Top of Page]
     47[[br]]
  • wiki/pages/nl/Installation-Recovery-Mips-Sezam

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2----
     3'''8.100 Sezam-Marvel''' [=#point8.100] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Sprachauswahl])
     4----
     5
     6manufacturer blurb....
     7
     8
     9
     10
     11
     12----
     13'''8.101 Sezam-Marvel''' [=#point8.101] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Sprachauswahl])
     14----
     15''How do I install a Sezam-Marvel  update image? ''
     16 * Visit the AAF digital forum and download the latest TitanNit firmware . ([#point8.33 IRD Download Locations])
     17 * Extract the zip file
     18 * Now copy the unzipped firmware folder "enigma2" to a formatted FAT32 USB stick.
     19    Note: The USB stick should not be formatted with windows, but a separate program, such as the " HP USB Disk Storage Format Tool" (freeware program). Furthermore, we recommend a cheap USB stick with a small storage capacity as well as read and write speed.
     20 * Turn off the Receiver and disconnect all USB devices.
     21 * Connect the USB stick with the update image file
     22 * Switch on (mains switch) and and when prompted on the vfd press the __Volume up__ button on the unit, then the installation begins. after the update starts release the __volume up__ button.
     23
     24Note: If installation does not start, use a different USB stick.
     25•After successfully installing the receiver will reboot and the installed image should start-up
     26[[br]]
     27[#point8 Top of Page]
     28[[br]]
     29----
     30'''8.102 Sezam-1000HD''' [=#point8.102] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Sprachauswahl])
     31----
     32''How do I install a Sezam-1000HD  update image? ''
     33 * Visit the AAF digital forum and download the latest TitanNit firmware . ([#point8.33 IRD Download Locations])
     34 * Extract the zip file
     35 * Now copy the unzipped firmware folder "enigma2" to a formatted FAT32 USB stick.
     36    Note: The USB stick should not be formatted with windows, but a separate program, such as the " HP USB Disk Storage Format Tool" (freeware program). Furthermore, we recommend a cheap USB stick with a small storage capacity as well as read and write speed.
     37 * Turn off the Receiver and disconnect all USB devices.
     38 * Connect the USB stick with the update image file
     39 * Switch on (mains switch) and and when prompted on the vfd press the __Volume up__ button on the unit, then the installation begins. after the update starts release the __volume up__ button.
     40
     41Note: If installation does not start, use a different USB stick.
     42•After successfully installing the receiver will reboot and the installed image should start-up
     43[[br]]
     44[#point8 Top of Page]
     45[[br]]
  • wiki/pages/nl/Installation-Recovery-SH4-Atemio

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2----
     3'''SH4 Atemio (Atevio)'''[=#point8.00]
     4----
     5
     6The SH4 Atemio recievers are manufactured by Fortis who are a Korean manufacturer of satellite receivers all atemio (atevio) models are compatible with TitanNit.
     7as TitanNit was developed for these recievers no bootloader software ID changes are required to install TitanNit, some of these models cam factory supplied with TitanNit such as the atemio  530.
     8
     9'''SH4 Atemio Contents'''
     10
     11 * [#point8.001 8.001 Atemio510]
     12 * [#point8.002 8.002 Atemio520]
     13 * [#point8.003 8.003 Atemio530]
     14 * [#point8.004 8.004 Atemio7600]
     15 * [#point8.005 8.005 Atevio700]
     16 * [#point8.006 8.006 Atevio7000]
     17
     18'''Additional Info'''
     19
     20 * [#point8.007 8.007 Uninstallation]
     21 * [#point8.008 8.008 Update TitanNit]
     22 * [#point8.009 8.009 IRD Download Location]
     23
     24
     25
     26----
     27'''8.1 Atemio510 and Fortis HS-7810''' [=#point8.001] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     28----
     29'' How do I install an Atemio 510 IRD image? ''
     30 * Visit the Atemio homepage or the AAF digital forum and download the latest TitanNit firmware . ([#point8.15 IRD Download Locations])
     31 * Extract the zip file
     32 * Now copy the unzipped IRD firmware file to a formatted FAT32 USB stick.
     33     Note: The USB stick should not be formatted with windows. Use a separate program, such as the
     34     " HP USB Disk Storage Format Tool" (freeware program).
     35     Furthermore, we recommend a cheap USB stick with a small storage capacity as well as read and write speed.
     36 * Turn off the Receiver and disconnect all USB devices.
     37 * Connect the USB stick with the IRD file to your Receiver
     38 * Switch on (mains switch) and at the same time hold the CH + on the unit (about 15 seconds) until "search IRD File ... " appears,
     39   and the installation begins. Only then release the button
     40     Note: If installation does not start , use a different USB stick.
     41 * After successfully installing the receiver will reboot and the installed image should start-up
     42[[br]]
     43  '''[wiki:Remote-Device-Control#point4.6 4.6 Bootloader sh4 Boxen]'''[[br]]
     44* [http://sbnc.dyndns.tv/trac/wiki/en/Remote-Device-Control#point4.6  iboot sh4 loader flashing and recovery ][[br]] 
     45[#point8 Top of Page]
     46[[br]]
     47----
     48'''8.2 Atemio520''' [=#point8.002] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     49----
     50'' How do I install an Atemio 520 IRD image? ''
     51 * Visit the Atemio homepage or the AAF digital forum and download the latest TitanNit firmware . ([#point8.15 IRD Download Locations])
     52 * Extract the zip file
     53 * Now copy the unzipped IRD firmware file to a formatted FAT32 USB stick.
     54     Note: The USB stick should not be formatted with windows. Use a separate program, such as the
     55     " HP USB Disk Storage Format Tool" (freeware program).
     56     Furthermore, we recommend a cheap USB stick with a small storage capacity as well as read and write speed.
     57 * Turn off the Receiver and disconnect all USB devices.
     58 * Connect the USB stick with the IRD file to your Receiver
     59 * Switch on (mains switch) and at the same time hold the CH + on the unit (about 15 seconds) until "search IRD File ... " appears,
     60   and the installation begins. Only then release the button
     61     Note: If installation does not start , use a different USB stick.
     62 * After successfully installing the receiver will reboot and the installed image should start-up
     63[[br]]
     64  '''[wiki:Remote-Device-Control#point4.6 4.6 Bootloader sh4 Boxen]'''[[br]]
     65* [http://sbnc.dyndns.tv/trac/wiki/en/Remote-Device-Control#point4.6  iboot sh4 loader flashing and recovery ][[br]] 
     66[#point8 Top of Page]
     67[[br]]
     68----
     69'''8.3 Atemio530''' [=#point8.003] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     70----
     71'' How do I install an Atemio 530 IRD image? ''
     72 * Visit the Atemio homepage or the AAF digital forum and download the latest TitanNit firmware . ([#point8.15 IRD Download Locations])
     73 * Extract the zip file
     74 * Now copy the unzipped IRD firmware file to a formatted FAT32 USB stick.
     75     Note: The USB stick should not be formatted with windows. Use a separate program, such as the
     76     " HP USB Disk Storage Format Tool" (freeware program).
     77     Furthermore, we recommend a cheap USB stick with a small storage capacity as well as read and write speed.
     78 * Turn off the Receiver and disconnect all USB devices.
     79 * Connect the USB stick with the IRD file to your Receiver
     80 * Switch on (mains switch) and at the same time hold the CH + on the unit (about 15 seconds) until "search IRD File ... " appears,
     81   and the installation begins. Only then release the button
     82     Note: If installation does not start , use a different USB stick.
     83 * After successfully installing the receiver will reboot and the installed image should start-up
     84[[br]]
     85[#point8 Top of Page]
     86[[br]]
     87----
     88'''8.4 Atemio7600 and Fortis HX-8200''' [=#point8.004] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     89----
     90'' How do I install an Atemio 7600 IRD image? ''
     91 * Visit the Atemio homepage or the AAF digital forum and download the latest TitanNit firmware . ([#point8.15 IRD Download Locations])
     92 * Extract the zip file
     93 * Now copy the unzipped IRD firmware file to a formatted FAT32 USB stick.
     94     Note: The USB stick should not be formatted with windows. Use a separate program, such as the
     95     " HP USB Disk Storage Format Tool" (freeware program).
     96     Furthermore, we recommend a cheap USB stick with a small storage capacity as well as read and write speed.
     97 * Turn off the Receiver and disconnect all USB devices.
     98 * Connect the USB stick with the IRD file to your Receiver
     99 * Switch on (mains switch) and at the same time hold the CH + on the unit (about 15 seconds) until "search IRD File ... " appears,
     100   and the installation begins. Only then release the button
     101     Note: If installation does not start , use a different USB stick.
     102 * After successfully installing the receiver will reboot and the installed image should start-up
     103[[br]]
     104  '''[wiki:Remote-Device-Control#point4.6 4.6 Bootloader sh4 Boxen]'''[[br]]
     105* [http://sbnc.dyndns.tv/trac/wiki/en/Remote-Device-Control#point4.6  iboot sh4 loader flashing and recovery ][[br]] 
     106[#point8 Top of Page]
     107[[br]]
     108----
     109'''8.5 Atevio700''' [=#point8.005] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     110----
     111'' How do I install an Atemio 7600 IRD image? ''
     112 * Visit the Atemio homepage or the AAF digital forum and download the latest TitanNit firmware . ([#point8.15 IRD Download Locations])
     113 * Extract the zip file
     114 * Now copy the unzipped IRD firmware file to a formatted FAT32 USB stick.
     115     Note: The USB stick should not be formatted with windows. Use a separate program, such as the
     116     " HP USB Disk Storage Format Tool" (freeware program).
     117     Furthermore, we recommend a cheap USB stick with a small storage capacity as well as read and write speed.
     118 * Turn off the Receiver and disconnect all USB devices.
     119 * Connect the USB stick with the IRD file to your Receiver
     120 * Switch on (mains switch) and at the same time hold the CH + on the unit (about 15 seconds) until "search IRD File ... " appears,
     121   and the installation begins. Only then release the button
     122     Note: If installation does not start , use a different USB stick.
     123 * After successfully installing the receiver will reboot and the installed image should start-up
     124[[br]]
     125  '''[wiki:Remote-Device-Control#point4.6 4.6 Bootloader sh4 Boxen]'''[[br]]
     126* [http://sbnc.dyndns.tv/trac/wiki/en/Remote-Device-Control#point4.6  iboot sh4 loader flashing and recovery ][[br]] 
     127[#point8 Top of Page]
     128[[br]]
     129----
     130'''8.6 Atevio7000 and Fortis FS-9000/9200''' [=#point8.006] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     131----
     132'' How do I install an Atemio 7000 IRD image? ''
     133 * Visit the Atemio homepage or the AAF digital forum and download the latest TitanNit firmware . ([#point8.15 IRD Download Locations])
     134 * Extract the zip file
     135 * Now copy the unzipped IRD firmware file to a formatted FAT32 USB stick.
     136     Note: The USB stick should not be formatted with windows. Use a separate program, such as the
     137     " HP USB Disk Storage Format Tool" (freeware program).
     138     Furthermore, we recommend a cheap USB stick with a small storage capacity as well as read and write speed.
     139 * Turn off the Receiver and disconnect all USB devices.
     140 * Connect the USB stick with the IRD file to your Receiver
     141 * Switch on (mains switch) and at the same time hold the CH + on the unit (about 15 seconds) until "search IRD File ... " appears,
     142   and the installation begins. Only then release the button
     143     Note: If installation does not start , use a different USB stick.
     144 * After successfully installing the receiver will reboot and the installed image should start-up
     145[[br]]
     146  '''[wiki:Remote-Device-Control#point4.6 4.6 Bootloader sh4 Boxen]'''[[br]]
     147* [http://sbnc.dyndns.tv/trac/wiki/en/Remote-Device-Control#point4.6  iboot sh4 loader flashing and recovery ][[br]] 
     148[#point8 Top of Page]
     149[[br]]
     150
     151----
     152'''8.007 Uninstalling Titan''' [=#point8.007] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     153----
     154If you have an Atemio (Atevio) receiver all you have to do is install your original ird file as explained above and no bootloader changes are neccessary.
     155
     156
     157[[br]]
     158[#point8 Top of Page]
     159[[br]]
     160
     161----   
     162'''8.008 Update TitanNit''' [=#point8.008] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main Page]) 
     163----
     164There are two ways to update your TitanNit version and there are merits to both methods :
     165
     166IRD offline method see above [#point8.00 SH4 Atemio contents] and select your Reciever model to show information on how to update titan using an IRD titannit image.
     167[[br]]
     168''Note: using this method plugins and files stored to Flash will be formatted when the update is proformed.
     169Plugins and files installed to MNT (except on the ufs 910/922) or a valid configured storage device will retain there settings .''
     170
     171Image Online Method see [wiki:System-Update#point3.5.7 System update] for information on how preform an online update.
     172[[br]]
     173''Note: using this method all plugins and settings are retained as long as they are not installed in flash.''
     174[[br]]
     175[#point8 Top of Page]
     176[[br]]
     177
     178----   
     179'''8.009 IRD Download Locations''' [=#point8.009] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main Page]) 
     180----
     181* [wiki:Manufactures#point13 13 Manufactures] - [http://atemio.de/index.php/software-updates Stable Images][[br]] 
     182* [wiki:Community#point14 14 Community] - [http://www.aaf-digital.info/forum/downloads.php?do=cat&id=2 Stable Images] [http://www.aaf-digital.info/forum/pages.php?pageid=12 Nightly Images][[br]] 
     183 
     184[[br]] 
     185[#point8 Top of Page] 
     186[[br]]
  • wiki/pages/nl/Installation-Recovery-SH4-Fortis

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2----
     3'''SH4 Fortis (hardware profile)'''[=#point8.010]
     4----
     5
     6Fortis is a Korean manufacture of satellite receivers that have a range of models that are compatible with TitanNit. These receivers were sold around the world to various resellers with customized bootloaders to lock them to a specific sales region, TitanNit installation is possible after the installation of a Atevio compatible bootloader.
     7
     8'''SH4 Fortis Contents'''
     9
     10 * [#point8.011 8.011 SH4 Fortis based clone receiver detection based on hardware profile]
     11 * [#point8.012 8.012 Fortis HS-7810 (Atemio510)]
     12 * [#point8.013 8.013 Fortis HX-8200 (Atemio7600)]
     13 * [#point8.014 8.014 Fortis HS-9510 (Atevio700)]
     14 * [#point8.015 8.015 Fortis FS-9000/9200 (Atevio7000)]
     15
     16'''Additional Info'''
     17
     18 * [#point8.012 8.016 Bootloader Installation] (required for a fortis/clone reciever to accept atemio software)
     19 * [#point8.111 8.017 Uninstallation On other Fortis Receivers]
     20 * [#point8.112 8.018 Update TitanNit]
     21 * [#point8.113 8.019 IRD Download Location]
     22
     23
     24
     25----
     26'''SH4 Fortis based clone receiver detection based on hardware profile''' [=#point8.011]
     27----
     28
     29As it is virtually impossible to list every fortis clone box on this wiki and data would be repeated over and over again it is broken up into harware revisions to compair that to the atevio model of that box.
     30This list will help you select the correct image and bootloader for your clone reciever below is a specifications list check the back of your manual included with your receiver and look at the table below to select the correct hardware model.
     31See here for a full list of known Fortis ([wiki:Supported-Receivers#point7 Supported Receivers])
     32
     33{{{#!div style="width: 1000px; margin: auto"
     34||'''Model System'''||'''Tuner'''||'''CPU'''||'''RAM'''||'''ROM (Flash)'''||'''USB'''||'''PVR Funktion'''||'''CardReader'''||'''Common interface'''||'''Display'''||'''Width'''||'''features'''||
     35||[#point8.015 Fortis FS-9000 HD PVR]||DVB-S/S2 2||STI_7101 266 Mhz||192MB||32MB||2||Internal 2.5 or 3.5 SATA, external via USB||1 (*2)||2||12-digit 5x7matrix||43 cm|| ||
     36||[#point8.015 Fortis FS-9200 HD PVR]||DVB-S/S2 2||STI_7101 266 Mhz||192MB||32MB||2||eSATA & USB||1 (*2)||2||12-digit 5x7matrix||34 cm|| ||
     37||[#point8.014 Fortis HS-9510]||DVB-S/S2 1||STI_7101 266 Mhz||192MB||32MB||1||USB||1 (*2)||2||8-digit 14segment||34 cm|| ||
     38||[#point8.013 Fortis HX-8200 HD PVR]||DVB-S/S2, DVB-T2, DVB-C 1/2||STI_7105 450 Mhz||256MB||64MB||3||Internal 2,5´´SATA-HDD external via eSATA + USB||2||2||12-digit 5x7matrix||34 cm||Plug&Play Tuner, Youtube, Browser, FreeTV+||
     39||[#point8.012 Fortis HS-7810 HD PVR]||DVB-S/S2 1||STI_7110 450 Mhz||256MB||32MB||2||USB||1||2||4-digit 7segment||26 cm||YouTube, Browser, FreeTV+||
     40}}}
     41'''NOTE:'''[[BR]]
     42 * The Fortis HS-7810 is a clone of the Atemio510/520 Models[[BR]]
     43 * The Fortis HX-8200 is a clone of the Atemio7600 Model[[BR]]
     44 * The Fortis HS-9510 is a clone of the Atemio700 clone Model[[BR]]
     45 * The Fortis FS-9000/Fortis FS-9200 is a clone of the Atemio7000 Models
     46
     47[[br]]
     48[#point8 Top of Page]
     49[[br]]
     50
     51----
     52'''8.1 Fortis HS-7810 (Atemio510)''' [=#point8.012] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     53----
     54'' How do I install an Atemio 510 IRD image? ''
     55 * Visit the Atemio homepage or the AAF digital forum and download the latest TitanNit firmware . ([#point8.15 IRD Download Locations])
     56 * Extract the zip file
     57 * Now copy the unzipped IRD firmware file to a formatted FAT32 USB stick.
     58     Note: The USB stick should not be formatted with windows. Use a separate program, such as the
     59     " HP USB Disk Storage Format Tool" (freeware program).
     60     Furthermore, we recommend a cheap USB stick with a small storage capacity as well as read and write speed.
     61 * Turn off the Receiver and disconnect all USB devices.
     62 * Connect the USB stick with the IRD file to your Receiver
     63 * Switch on (mains switch) and at the same time hold the CH + on the unit (about 15 seconds) until "search IRD File ... " appears,
     64   and the installation begins. Only then release the button
     65     Note: If installation does not start , use a different USB stick.
     66 * After successfully installing the receiver will reboot and the installed image should start-up
     67[[br]]
     68[#point8 Top of Page]
     69[[br]]
     70----
     71'''8.4 Fortis HX-8200 (Atemio7600)''' [=#point8.013] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     72----
     73'' How do I install an Atemio 7600 IRD image? ''
     74 * Visit the Atemio homepage or the AAF digital forum and download the latest TitanNit firmware . ([#point8.15 IRD Download Locations])
     75 * Extract the zip file
     76 * Now copy the unzipped IRD firmware file to a formatted FAT32 USB stick.
     77     Note: The USB stick should not be formatted with windows. Use a separate program, such as the
     78     " HP USB Disk Storage Format Tool" (freeware program).
     79     Furthermore, we recommend a cheap USB stick with a small storage capacity as well as read and write speed.
     80 * Turn off the Receiver and disconnect all USB devices.
     81 * Connect the USB stick with the IRD file to your Receiver
     82 * Switch on (mains switch) and at the same time hold the CH + on the unit (about 15 seconds) until "search IRD File ... " appears,
     83   and the installation begins. Only then release the button
     84     Note: If installation does not start , use a different USB stick.
     85 * After successfully installing the receiver will reboot and the installed image should start-up
     86[[br]]
     87[#point8 Top of Page]
     88[[br]]
     89----
     90'''8.5 Fortis HS-9510 (Atevio700)''' [=#point8.014] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     91----
     92'' How do I install an Fortis HS-9510 IRD image? ''
     93 * Visit the Atemio homepage or the AAF digital forum and download the latest TitanNit firmware . ([#point8.15 IRD Download Locations])
     94 * Extract the zip file
     95 * Now copy the unzipped IRD firmware file to a formatted FAT32 USB stick.
     96     Note: The USB stick should not be formatted with windows. Use a separate program, such as the
     97     " HP USB Disk Storage Format Tool" (freeware program).
     98     Furthermore, we recommend a cheap USB stick with a small storage capacity as well as read and write speed.
     99 * Turn off the Receiver and disconnect all USB devices.
     100 * Connect the USB stick with the IRD file to your Receiver
     101 * Switch on (mains switch) and at the same time hold the CH + on the unit (about 15 seconds) until "search IRD File ... " appears,
     102   and the installation begins. Only then release the button
     103     Note: If installation does not start , use a different USB stick.
     104 * After successfully installing the receiver will reboot and the installed image should start-up
     105[[br]]
     106[#point8 Top of Page]
     107[[br]]
     108----
     109'''8.6 Fortis FS-9000/9200 (Atevio7000)''' [=#point8.015] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     110----
     111'' How do I install an Fortis FS-9000/9200 IRD image? ''
     112 * Visit the Atemio homepage or the AAF digital forum and download the latest TitanNit firmware . ([#point8.15 IRD Download Locations])
     113 * Extract the zip file
     114 * Now copy the unzipped IRD firmware file to a formatted FAT32 USB stick.
     115     Note: The USB stick should not be formatted with windows. Use a separate program, such as the
     116     " HP USB Disk Storage Format Tool" (freeware program).
     117     Furthermore, we recommend a cheap USB stick with a small storage capacity as well as read and write speed.
     118 * Turn off the Receiver and disconnect all USB devices.
     119 * Connect the USB stick with the IRD file to your Receiver
     120 * Switch on (mains switch) and at the same time hold the CH + on the unit (about 15 seconds) until "search IRD File ... " appears,
     121   and the installation begins. Only then release the button
     122     Note: If installation does not start , use a different USB stick.
     123 * After successfully installing the receiver will reboot and the installed image should start-up
     124[[br]]
     125[#point8 Top of Page]
     126[[br]]
     127
     128'''Aditional Info'''
     129----
     130'''8.012 installation on other Fortis Receivers'''  [=#point8.016] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     131----
     132'''Installation Notes:'''
     133
     134''If you wish to try or install titan you need to install an Atemio/Atevio factory loader. The original Atemio Bootloader has a security code within so an installation of Titan is not possible with any other fortis loader''
     135
     136''If you wish to install Titan the loader version must be 1.54 or above. Titan versions above 1.32 require the new Iboot loader which needs to be installed first if not present.''
     137
     138''There are various ways that are explained below:''
     139 
     140[[br]]
     141
     142'''AAF Recovery Tool (ART) method'''
     143
     144 * Install the AAF Recovery Tool (ART) and set up a connection to your receiver
     145 * Set the IP address and subnet mask of your uboot environment.
     146 * Reboot the receiver and reconnect to change the settings.
     147 * Install the factory loader and reboot.
     148 * The factory loader you installed is version 1.21 that you have to update to 1.54 to be compatible with Titan
     149 * Visit the [http:((www-atemio.de Atemio] homepage or the [http://www.aaf-digital.info/forum AAF digital forum] and download the latest Atevio/Atemio loaader (1.54).
     150 * Extract the zip file
     151  * Now copy the unzipped IRD firmware file to a formatted FAT32 USB stick.
     152     Note: The USB stick should not be formatted with windows. Use a separate program, such as the
     153     "HP USB Disk Storage Format Tool" (freeware program).
     154     Furthermore, we recommend a cheap USB stick with a small storage capacity as well as read and write speed.
     155 * Turn off the receiver and disconnect all USB devices.
     156 * Connect the USB stick with the IRD file to your receiver
     157 * Switch on (mains switch) and at the same time hold the CH + on the unit (about 15 seconds) until "search IRD File ... " appears,
     158   and the installation begins. Only then release the button
     159     Note: Should the installation not start, try a different USB stick.
     160 * Should you have installed the loader successfully the receiver will reboot and the installed Loader should start-up.
     161
     162''You may now install Titan''
     163[[br]]
     164[#point8 Top of Page]
     165[[br]]
     166
     167'''Cross Flash Method'''
     168
     169''This method explains how to install the HDF bootloader flash plugin to your fortis receiver and flash an Atemio/Atevio compatible bootloader from the plugin menu.''
     170
     171* Download the HDF Bootloader flash plugin from the [http://www.aaf-digital.info/forum AAF Digital forum].
     172 * Extract the zip file
     173 * Now copy the unzipped Plugin folder to a formatted FAT32 USB stick.
     174     Note: The USB stick should not be formatted with windows. Use a separate program, such as the
     175     " HP USB Disk Storage Format Tool" (freeware program).
     176     Furthermore, we recommend a cheap USB stick with a small storage capacity as well as read and write speed.
     177 * go to the plugins section in your receiver and install the plugin and then start it.
     178 * type in the password contained in the zip file and follow the onscreen prompts.
     179 * Should you have installed the loader successfully the receiver will reboot and the installed Loader should start-up.
     180
     181''You may now install TitanNit''
     182[[br]]
     183[#point8 Top of Page]
     184[[br]]
     185
     186'''Reseller Changer Tool Method'''
     187
     188''This method explains how to change the Reseler ID of an Atemio/Atevio compatible bootloader and flash it to any compatible Fortis receiver from the plugin menu.''
     189
     190
     191* Visit the [http://www.atemio.de Atemio] homepage or the [http://www.aaf-digital.info/forum AAF digital forum] and download the latest Atevio/Atemio loader.
     192 * Extract the zip file
     193 * use the reseller ID changer tool and change the IRD to that of your reseller ID.
     194 * Now copy the unzipped IRD firmware file to a formatted FAT32 USB stick.
     195     Note: The USB stick should not be formatted with windows. Use a separate program, such as the
     196     " HP USB Disk Storage Format Tool" (freeware program).
     197     Furthermore, we recommend a cheap USB stick with a small storage capacity as well as read and write speed.
     198 * Turn off the Receiver and disconnect all USB devices.
     199 * Connect the USB stick with the IRD file to your Receiver.
     200 * Switch on (mains switch) and at the same time hold the CH + on the unit (about 15 seconds) until "search IRD File ... " appears,
     201   and the installation begins. Only then release the button
     202     Note: If installation does not start , use a different USB stick.
     203 * Should you have installed the loader successfully the receiver will reboot and the installed Loader should start-up.
     204
     205
     206This method requires you to also change the reseller ID to be able to install TitanNit.
     207
     208
     209'''Be aware should it the installation fail or a loss of Power occur during the flashing process you could brick your receiver as there is no recovery method. Compatibility with other receivers is not guaranteed but you may find a list of compatible receivers in the [wiki:Supported-Receivers#point7 Supported Receivers] section.'''
     210[[br]]
     211[#point8 Top of Page]
     212[[br]]
     213----
     214'''8.111 Uninstalling Titan''' [=#point8.017] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     215----
     216If you have an Atemio/Atevio or UFS receiver all you have to do is install your original ird file as explained above and no bootloader changes are neccessary.
     217
     218Uninstalling titan and switching back to the original reseller loader can't be done (easily) for other fortis receivers but there is one simple alternative method outlined below.
     219
     220
     221'''Uninstalling Titan on non Atemio/Atevio receiver and restore Reseller ID with Maxi-uboot'''
     222
     223If you have iboot installed then you must install a version of TitanNit older than 1.32 before using this method.
     224
     225This will install the factory Atemio loader that is compatible with the AAF Recovery Tool (ART) to be able to install the Maxiuboot Loader.
     226
     227In order for this method to work make sure the setting Allow __"Iboot Update"__ is enabled in [wiki:Remote-Device-Control#point4.6 Iboot].
     228
     229When successfully achieved you may start up ART from your PC and install Maxiuboot.
     230
     231[[br]]
     232
     233Once installed you may set up your bootargs and change your Reseller ID back to its factory settings. For flashin original Firmware or other Software please refere to your receivers' manual or instructions.
     234[[br]]
     235[#point8 Top of Page]
     236[[br]]
     237
     238----   
     239'''8.112 Update TitanNit''' [=#point8.018] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main Page]) 
     240----
     241There are two ways to update your TitanNit version and there are merits to both methods :
     242
     243IRD offline method see [#point8 Installation / Recovery] and select your Reciever model to show information on how to update titan using an IRD titannit image.
     244[[br]]
     245''Note: using this method plugins and files stored to Flash will be formatted when the update is proformed.
     246Plugins and files installed to MNT (except on the ufs 910/922) or a valid configured storage device will retain there settings .''
     247
     248Image Online Method see [wiki:System-Update#point3.5.7 System update] for information on how preform an online update.
     249[[br]]
     250''Note: using this method all plugins and settings are retained as long as they are not installed in flash.''
     251[[br]]
     252[#point8 Top of Page]
     253[[br]]
     254
     255----   
     256'''8.113 IRD Download Locations''' [=#point8.019] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main Page]) 
     257----
     258* [wiki:Manufactures#point13 13 Manufactures] - [http://atemio.de/index.php/software-updates Stable Images][[br]] 
     259* [wiki:Community#point14 14 Community] - [http://www.aaf-digital.info/forum/downloads.php?do=cat&id=2 Stable Images] [http://www.aaf-digital.info/forum/pages.php?pageid=12 Nightly Images][[br]] 
     260 
     261[[br]] 
     262[#point8 Top of Page] 
     263[[br]]
  • wiki/pages/nl/Installation-Recovery-SH4-Homecast

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2----
     3'''8.020 Homecast''' [=#point8.020] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4----
     5
     6Fortis is a Korean manufacture of satellite receivers that have a range of models that are compatible with TitanNit. These receivers were sold around the world to various resellers with customized bootloaders to lock them to a specific sales region, TitanNit installation is possible after the installation of a Atevio compatible bootloader.
     7
     8'''SH4 Homecast Contents'''
     9
     10 * [#point8.021 8.021 Homecast pro]
     11
     12
     13'''Additional Info'''
     14
     15 * [#point8.022 8.022 Uninstallation]
     16 * [#point8.023 8.025 Update TitanNit]
     17 * [#point8.024 8.024 IRD Download Location]
     18
     19----
     20'''8.021 Homecast Pro''' [=#point8.021] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     21----
     22'' How do I install an Homecast UPDATEUSB Image? ''
     23 * Visit the Atemio homepage or the AAF digital forum and download the latest TitanNit firmware . ([#point8.2 IRD Download Locations])
     24 * Extract the zip file
     25 * Now copy the unzipped IMG firmware file to a formatted FAT32 USB stick.
     26     Note: The USB stick should not be formatted with windows. Use a separate program, such as the
     27     " HP USB Disk Storage Format Tool" (freeware program).
     28     Furthermore, we recommend a cheap USB stick with a small storage capacity as well as read and write speed.
     29 * Turn off the Receiver and disconnect all USB devices.
     30 * Connect the USB stick with the IMG file to your Receiver
     31* Switch on (mains plug) while holding in the Power button on the unit (one button from the left) hold it down (about 3 seconds) until "LOAD SW" appears,
     32    then the installation starts. Only then release the button
     33     Note: If installation does not start, use a different USB stick.
     34 * The installation is finished when DONE appears on the receiver.
     35 * Restart the machine after by the main switch again to .
     36[[br]]
     37[#point8 Top of Page]
     38[[br]]
     39
     40----
     41'''8.022 Uninstalling Titan''' [=#point8.022] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     42----
     43If you have an Homecast receiver all you have to do is install your original IMG file as explained above and no bootloader changes are necessary.
     44
     45[[br]]
     46[#point8 Top of Page]
     47[[br]]
     48
     49----   
     50'''8.023 Update TitanNit''' [=#point8.023] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main Page]) 
     51----
     52There are two ways to update your TitanNit version and there are merits to both methods :
     53
     54IRD offline method see [#point8.020 Homecast Contents] and select your Receiver model to show information on how to update titan using an IRD TitanNit image.
     55[[br]]
     56''Note: using this method plugins and files stored to Flash will be formatted when the update is preformed.
     57Plugins and files installed to MNT or a valid configured storage device will retain there settings .''
     58
     59Image Online Method see [wiki:System-Update#point3.5.7 System update] for information on how preform an online update.
     60[[br]]
     61''Note: using this method all plugins and settings are retained as long as they are not installed in flash.''
     62[[br]]
     63[#point8 Top of Page]
     64[[br]]
     65
     66----   
     67'''8.024 IRD Download Locations''' [=#point8.024] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main Page]) 
     68----
     69
     70* [http://www.aaf-digital.info/forum/downloads.php?do=cat&id=2 Stable Images] [http://www.aaf-digital.info/forum/pages.php?pageid=12 Nightly Images][[br]] 
     71 
     72[[br]] 
     73[#point8 Top of Page] 
     74[[br]]
     75
  • wiki/pages/nl/Installation-Recovery-SH4-IPBox

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2----
     3'''8.031 Ipbox''' [=#point8.030] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4----
     5
     6Ipbox is a Korean manufacture of satellite receivers that have a range of models that are compatible with TitanNit. These receivers were sold around the world to various resellers with customized bootloaders to lock them to a specific sales region.
     7
     8'''SH4 Ipbox Contents'''
     9
     10 * [#point8.031 8.031 Ipbox91]
     11 * [#point8.032 8.032 Ipbox900]
     12 * [#point8.033 8.033 Ipbox910]
     13 * [#point8.034 8.034 Ipbox9000]
     14
     15'''Additional Info'''
     16
     17 * [#point8.035 8.035 Uninstallation]
     18 * [#point8.036 8.036 Update TitanNit]
     19 * [#point8.037 8.037 IRD Download Location]
     20
     21----
     22'''8.031 Ipbox91''' [=#point8.031] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     23----
     24'' How do I install an Ipbox 91 UPDATEUSB Image? ''
     25 * Visit the Atemio homepage or the AAF digital forum and download the latest TitanNit firmware . ([#point8.15 IRD Download Locations])
     26 * Extract the zip file
     27 * Now copy the unzipped IMG firmware file to a formatted FAT32 USB stick.
     28     Note: The USB stick should not be formatted with windows. Use a separate program, such as the
     29     " HP USB Disk Storage Format Tool" (freeware program).
     30     Furthermore, we recommend a cheap USB stick with a small storage capacity as well as read and write speed.
     31 * Turn off the Receiver and disconnect all USB devices.
     32 * Connect the USB stick with the IMG file to your Receiver
     33* Switch on (mains plug) while holding in the Power button on the unit (one button from the left) hold it down (about 3 seconds) until "LOAD SW" appears,
     34    then the installation starts. Only then release the button
     35     Note: If installation does not start, use a different USB stick.
     36 * The installation is finished when DONE appears on the receiver.
     37 * Restart the machine after by the main switch again to .
     38[[br]]
     39[#point8 Top of Page]
     40[[br]]
     41----
     42'''8.032 Ipbox900''' [=#point8.032] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     43----
     44'' How do I install an Ipbox 900 UPDATEUSB Image? ''
     45 * Visit the Atemio homepage or the AAF digital forum and download the latest TitanNit firmware . ([#point8.15 IRD Download Locations])
     46 * Extract the zip file
     47 * Now copy the unzipped IMG firmware file to a formatted FAT32 USB stick.
     48     Note: The USB stick should not be formatted with windows. Use a separate program, such as the
     49     " HP USB Disk Storage Format Tool" (freeware program).
     50     Furthermore, we recommend a cheap USB stick with a small storage capacity as well as read and write speed.
     51 * Turn off the Receiver and disconnect all USB devices.
     52 * Connect the USB stick with the IMG file to your Receiver
     53* Switch on (mains plug) while holding in the Power button on the unit (one button from the left) hold it down (about 3 seconds) until "LOAD SW" appears,
     54    then the installation starts. Only then release the button
     55     Note: If installation does not start, use a different USB stick.
     56 * The installation is finished when DONE appears on the receiver.
     57 * Restart the machine after by the main switch again to .
     58[[br]]
     59[#point8 Top of Page]
     60[[br]]
     61----
     62'''8.033 Ipbox910''' [=#point8.033] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     63----
     64'' How do I install an Ipbox 910 UPDATEUSB Image? ''
     65 * Visit the Atemio homepage or the AAF digital forum and download the latest TitanNit firmware . ([#point8.15 IRD Download Locations])
     66 * Extract the zip file
     67 * Now copy the unzipped IMG firmware file to a formatted FAT32 USB stick.
     68     Note: The USB stick should not be formatted with windows. Use a separate program, such as the
     69     " HP USB Disk Storage Format Tool" (freeware program).
     70     Furthermore, we recommend a cheap USB stick with a small storage capacity as well as read and write speed.
     71 * Turn off the Receiver and disconnect all USB devices.
     72 * Connect the USB stick with the IMG file to your Receiver
     73* Switch on (mains plug) while holding in the Power button on the unit (one button from the left) hold it down (about 3 seconds) until "LOAD SW" appears,
     74    then the installation starts. Only then release the button
     75     Note: If installation does not start, use a different USB stick.
     76 * The installation is finished when DONE appears on the receiver.
     77 * Restart the machine after by the main switch again to .
     78[[br]]
     79[#point8 Top of Page]
     80[[br]]
     81----
     82'''8.034 Ipbox9000''' [=#point8.034] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     83----
     84'' How do I install an Ipbox 9000 UPDATEUSB Image? ''
     85 * Visit the Atemio homepage or the AAF digital forum and download the latest TitanNit firmware . ([#point8.15 IRD Download Locations])
     86 * Extract the zip file
     87 * Now copy the unzipped IMG firmware file to a formatted FAT32 USB stick.
     88     Note: The USB stick should not be formatted with windows. Use a separate program, such as the
     89     " HP USB Disk Storage Format Tool" (freeware program).
     90     Furthermore, we recommend a cheap USB stick with a small storage capacity as well as read and write speed.
     91 * Turn off the Receiver and disconnect all USB devices.
     92 * Connect the USB stick with the IMG file to your Receiver
     93* Switch on (mains plug) while holding in the Power button on the unit (one button from the left) hold it down (about 3 seconds) until "LOAD SW" appears,
     94    then the installation starts. Only then release the button
     95     Note: If installation does not start, use a different USB stick.
     96 * The installation is finished when DONE appears on the receiver.
     97 * Restart the machine after by the main switch again to .
     98[[br]]
     99[#point8 Top of Page]
     100[[br]]
     101
     102----
     103'''8.035 Uninstalling Titan''' [=#point8.035] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     104----
     105If you have an Ipbox receiver all you have to do is install your original IMG file as explained above and no bootloader changes are neccessary.
     106
     107[[br]]
     108[#point8 Top of Page]
     109[[br]]
     110
     111----   
     112'''8.036 Update TitanNit''' [=#point8.036] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main Page]) 
     113----
     114There are two ways to update your TitanNit version and there are merits to both methods :
     115
     116IRD offline method see [#point8 Installation / Recovery] and select your Reciever model to show information on how to update titan using an IRD titannit image.
     117[[br]]
     118''Note: using this method plugins and files stored to Flash will be formatted when the update is proformed.
     119Plugins and files installed to MNT (except on the ufs 910/922) or a valid configured storage device will retain there settings .''
     120
     121Image Online Method see [wiki:System-Update#point3.5.7 System update] for information on how preform an online update.
     122[[br]]
     123''Note: using this method all plugins and settings are retained as long as they are not installed in flash.''
     124[[br]]
     125[#point8 Top of Page]
     126[[br]]
     127
     128----   
     129'''8.037 IRD Download Locations''' [=#point8.037] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main Page]) 
     130----
     131
     132* [wiki:Community#point14 14 Community] - [http://www.aaf-digital.info/forum/downloads.php?do=cat&id=2 Stable Images] [http://www.aaf-digital.info/forum/pages.php?pageid=12 Nightly Images][[br]] 
     133 
     134[[br]] 
     135[#point8 Top of Page] 
     136[[br]]
  • wiki/pages/nl/Installation-Recovery-SH4-Katherin

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2----
     3'''8.040 Kathrein''' [=#point8.040] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4----
     5
     6Fortis is a Korean manufacture of satellite receivers that have a range of models that are compatible with TitanNit. These receivers were sold around the world to various resellers with customized bootloaders to lock them to a specific sales region, TitanNit installation is possible after the installation of a Atevio compatible bootloader.
     7
     8'''SH4 Fortis Contents'''
     9
     10 * [#point8.041 8.041 Kathrein Ufs910]
     11 * [#point8.042 8.042 Kathrein Ufs912]
     12 * [#point8.043 8.043 Kathrein Ufs913]
     13 * [#point8.044 8.044 Kathrein Ufs922]
     14 * [#point8.045 8.045 Kathrein Ufs960]
     15
     16'''Additional Info'''
     17
     18 * [#point8.046 8.06 Uninstallation]
     19 * [#point8.047 8.07 Update TitanNit]
     20 * [#point8.048 8.08 IRD Download Location]
     21
     22----
     23'''8.041 Kathrein Ufs910''' [=#point8.041] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     24----
     25'' How do I install a Kathrein UFS910 update image? ''
     26 * When you install a USB .img file the mnt-filesystem is formatted. An Online Update leaves the mnt-filesystem untouched.
     27 * Visit the AAF digital forum and download the latest TitanNit firmware .  ([#point8.15 IRD Download Locations])
     28 * Extract the zip file
     29 * Now copy the unzipped img firmware file - must be renamed to miniFLASH.img - to a formatted FAT32 USB stick.
     30     Note: The USB stick should not be formatted with windows, but a separate program, such as the
     31     " HP USB Disk Storage Format Tool" (freeware program).
     32     Furthermore, we recommend a cheap USB stick with a small storage capacity as well as read and write speed.
     33 * Turn off the Receiver and disconnect all USB devices.
     34 * Connect the USB stick with the img file to the front USB Port
     35 * Switch on (mains switch) and at the same time hold the -Record button- on the Remote Control pressed (about 5 seconds)
     36   until "miniFLASH search..." appears, then the installation begins. Only then release the -Record button-
     37     Note: If installation does not start, use a different USB stick.
     38 * After successfully installing the receiver will reboot and the installed image should start-up
     39[[br]]
     40[#point8 Top of Page]
     41[[br]]
     42----
     43'''8.042 Kathrein UFS912''' [=#point8.042] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     44----
     45'' How do I install a Kathrein UFS912 update image? ''
     46 * Visit the AAF digital forum and download the latest TitanNit firmware .  ([#point8.15 IRD Download Locations])
     47 * Extract the zip file
     48 * Now copy the unzipped firmware file *_FULL_nodebug.img to a formatted FAT32 USB stick into the path: /kathrein/ufs912/ .
     49     Note: The USB stick should not be formatted with windows, but a separate program, such as the
     50     " HP USB Disk Storage Format Tool" (freeware program).
     51     Furthermore, we recommend a cheap USB stick with a small storage capacity as well as read and write speed.
     52 * Turn off the Receiver and disconnect all USB devices.
     53 * Connect the USB stick with the img file
     54 * Switch on (mains switch) and at the same time press the -TV/Radio button- on the unit (about 5 seconds) until "emergency boot" appears,
     55   then the installation begins. Only after that message release the -TV/Radio button-
     56     Note: If installation does not start, use a different USB stick.
     57 * After successfully installing the receiver will reboot and the installed image should start-up
     58[[br]]
     59[#point8.1 Top of Page]
     60[[br]]
     61----
     62'''8.043 Kathrein UFS913''' [=#point8.043] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     63----
     64'' How do I install a Kathrein UFS913 update image? ''
     65 * When you install a USB .img file the mnt-filesystem is formatted. An Online Update leaves the mnt-filesystem untouched.
     66 * Visit the AAF digital forum and download the latest TitanNit firmware .  ([#point8.15 IRD Download Locations])
     67 * Extract the zip file
     68 * Now copy the unzipped firmware file *_FULL_nodebug.img to a formatted FAT32 USB stick into the path: /kathrein/ufs922/ .
     69     Note: The USB stick should not be formatted with windows, but a separate program, such as the
     70     " HP USB Disk Storage Format Tool" (freeware program).
     71     Furthermore, we recommend a cheap USB stick with a small storage capacity as well as read and write speed.
     72 * Turn off the Receiver and disconnect all USB devices.
     73 * Connect the USB stick with the img file
     74 * Switch on (mains switch) and at the same time press the -TV/Radio button- on the unit (about 5 seconds) until "emergency boot" appears,
     75   then the installation begins. Only after that message release the -TV/Radio button-
     76     Note: If installation does not start, use a different USB stick.
     77 * After successfully installing the receiver will reboot and the installed image should start-up
     78[[br]]
     79[#point8.1 Top of Page]
     80[[br]]
     81----
     82'''8.044 Kathrein UFS922''' [=#point8.044] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     83----
     84'' How do I install a Kathrein UFS922 update image? ''
     85 * When you install a USB .img file the mnt-filesystem is formatted. An Online Update leaves the mnt-filesystem untouched.
     86 * Visit the AAF digital forum and download the latest TitanNit firmware .  ([#point8.15 IRD Download Locations])
     87 * Extract the zip file
     88 * Now copy the unzipped firmware file *_FULL_nodebug.img to a formatted FAT32 USB stick into the path: /kathrein/ufs922/ .
     89     Note: The USB stick should not be formatted with windows, but a separate program, such as the
     90     " HP USB Disk Storage Format Tool" (freeware program).
     91     Furthermore, we recommend a cheap USB stick with a small storage capacity as well as read and write speed.
     92 * Turn off the Receiver and disconnect all USB devices.
     93 * Connect the USB stick with the img file
     94 * Switch on (mains switch) and at the same time press the -TV/Radio button- on the unit (about 5 seconds) until "emergency boot" appears,
     95   then the installation begins. Only after that message release the -TV/Radio button-
     96     Note: If installation does not start, use a different USB stick.
     97 * After successfully installing the receiver will reboot and the installed image should start-up
     98[[br]]
     99[#point8 Top of Page]
     100[[br]]
     101----
     102'''8.045 Kathrein UFC960''' [=#point8.045] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     103----
     104'' How do I install a Kathrein UFS960 update image? ''
     105 * When you install a USB .img file the mnt-filesystem is formatted. An Online Update leaves the mnt-filesystem untouched.
     106 * Visit the AAF digital forum and download the latest TitanNit firmware .  ([#point8.15 IRD Download Locations])
     107 * Extract the zip file
     108 * Now copy the unzipped firmware file *_FULL_nodebug.img to a formatted FAT32 USB stick into the path: /kathrein/ufs960/ .
     109     Note: The USB stick should not be formatted with windows, but a separate program, such as the
     110     " HP USB Disk Storage Format Tool" (freeware program).
     111     Furthermore, we recommend a cheap USB stick with a small storage capacity as well as read and write speed.
     112 * Turn off the Receiver and disconnect all USB devices.
     113 * Connect the USB stick with the img file
     114 * Switch on (mains switch) and at the same time press the -TV/Radio button- on the unit (about 5 seconds) until "emergency boot" appears,
     115   then the installation begins. Only after that message release the -TV/Radio button-
     116     Note: If installation does not start, use a different USB stick.
     117 * After successfully installing the receiver will reboot and the installed image should start-up
     118[[br]]
     119[#point8 Top of Page]
     120[[br]]
     121
     122----
     123'''8.046 Uninstalling Titan''' [=#point8.046] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     124----
     125If you have an Katherin UFS receiver all you have to do is install your original IMG file as explained above and no bootloader changes are neccessary.
     126
     127[[br]]
     128[#point8 Top of Page]
     129[[br]]
     130
     131----   
     132'''8.047 Update TitanNit''' [=#point8.047] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main Page]) 
     133----
     134There are two ways to update your TitanNit version and there are merits to both methods :
     135
     136IRD offline method see [#point8 Ipbox contents] and select your Reciever model to show information on how to update titan using an IRD titannit image.
     137[[br]]
     138''Note: using this method plugins and files stored to Flash will be formatted when the update is proformed.
     139Plugins and files installed to MNT (except on the ufs 910/922) or a valid configured storage device will retain there settings .''
     140
     141Image Online Method see [wiki:System-Update#point3.5.7 System update] for information on how preform an online update.
     142[[br]]
     143''Note: using this method all plugins and settings are retained as long as they are not installed in flash.''
     144[[br]]
     145[#point8 Top of Page]
     146[[br]]
     147
     148----   
     149'''8.048 IRD Download Locations''' [=#point8.048] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main Page]) 
     150----
     151[http://www.aaf-digital.info/forum/downloads.php?do=cat&id=2 Stable Images] [http://www.aaf-digital.info/forum/pages.php?pageid=12 Nightly Images][[br]] 
     152 
     153[[br]] 
     154[#point8 Top of Page] 
     155[[br]]
  • wiki/pages/nl/Installation-Recovery-SH4-Spark

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2----
     3'''8.051 SPARK''' [=#point8.050] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4----
     5
     6Spark is a reseller of the Fulan Korean manufacture of satellite receivers that have a range of models that are compatible with TitanNit. These receivers were sold around the world to various resellers with customized hardware.
     7
     8'''SH4 Spark Contents'''
     9
     10 * [#point8.051 8.051 SPARK (7111)]
     11 * [#point8.052 8.052 SPARK (7162)]
     12
     13'''Additional Info'''
     14
     15
     16 * [#point8.053 8.053 Uninstallation]
     17 * [#point8.054 8.054 Update TitanNit]
     18 * [#point8.055 8.055 IRD Download Location]
     19
     20
     21
     22----
     23'''8.051 SPARK (7111)''' [=#point8.051] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     24----
     25'' How do I install a Spark (7111) Update Image? ''
     26  * Visit the AAF digital forum and download the latest TitanNit firmware .  ([#point8.15 IRD Download Locations])
     27  * Extract the zip file
     28  * Copy the unzipped firmware update file to a formatted to FAT32 USB stick and copy the file e2jffs2.img and uImage into a folder called "enigma2"
     29     Note: The USB stick should not be formatted with windows, but a separate program, such as the
     30     " HP USB Disk Storage Format Tool" (freeware program).
     31     Furthermore, we recommend a cheap USB stick with a small storage capacity as well as read and write speed.
     32  * Turn off the device.
     33  * Connect the USB stick with the update file
     34  * hold the "OK" button and switch on the(mains plug) and hold it down (about 5 seconds) until "Forc" appears,
     35    then the installation will begin, when you see "U LD" in the display release the "OK" button.
     36      Note: If the installation does not start, use a different USB stick.
     37  * After installation "SUCC" appears in the display boot the receiver and the new image should appear.
     38[[br]]
     39[#point8.050 Top of Page]
     40[[br]]
     41----
     42'''8.052 SPARK7162''' [=#point8.052] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     43----
     44'' How do I install a Spark (7162) Update Image? ''
     45  * Visit the AAF digital forum and download the latest TitanNit firmware .  ([#point8.15 IRD Download Locations])
     46  * Extract the zip file
     47  * Copy the unzipped firmware update file to a formatted to FAT32 USB stick and copy the file e2jffs2.img and uImage into a folder called "enigma2"
     48     Note: The USB stick should not be formatted with windows, but a separate program, such as the
     49     " HP USB Disk Storage Format Tool" (freeware program).
     50     Furthermore, we recommend a cheap USB stick with a small storage capacity as well as read and write speed.
     51  * Turn off the device.
     52  * Connect the USB stick with the update file
     53  * hold the "OK" button and switch on the(mains plug) and hold it down (about 5 seconds) until "Forc" appears,
     54    then the installation will begin, when you see "U LD" in the display release the "OK" button.
     55      Note: If the installation does not start, use a different USB stick.
     56  * After installation "SUCC" appears in the display boot the receiver and the new image should appear.
     57[[br]]
     58[#point8.050 Top of Page]
     59[[br]]
     60
     61----
     62'''8.053 Uninstalling Titan''' [=#point8.053] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     63----
     64If you have an Atemio/Atevio or UFS receiver all you have to do is install your original ird file as explained above and no bootloader changes are neccessary.
     65
     66[[br]]
     67[#point8.050 Top of Page]
     68[[br]]
     69
     70----   
     71'''8.054 Update TitanNit''' [=#point8.054] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main Page]) 
     72----
     73There are two ways to update your TitanNit version and there are merits to both methods :
     74
     75IRD offline method see [#point8 Installation / Recovery] and select your Receiver model to show information on how to update titan using an IRD TitanNit image.
     76[[br]]
     77''Note: using this method plugins and files stored to Flash will be formatted when the update is preformed.
     78Plugins and files installed to MNT (except on the ufs 910/922) or a valid configured storage device will retain there settings .''
     79
     80Image Online Method see [wiki:System-Update#point3.5.7 System update] for information on how preform an online update.
     81[[br]]
     82''Note: using this method all plugins and settings are retained as long as they are not installed in flash.''
     83[[br]]
     84[#point8.050 Top of Page]
     85[[br]]
     86
     87----   
     88'''8.055 IRD Download Locations''' [=#point8.055] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main Page]) 
     89----
     90[http://www.aaf-digital.info/forum/downloads.php?do=cat&id=2 Stable Images] [http://www.aaf-digital.info/forum/pages.php?pageid=12 Nightly Images][[br]] 
     91 
     92[[br]] 
     93[#point8.050 Top of Page] 
     94[[br]]
  • wiki/pages/nl/Interface-Operation

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2----
     3'''3 Interface and Operation Contents''' [=#point3] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4New Gui section work in progress expect dead links or missing data.
     5----
     6== Interface and Operation ==
     7
     8This section contains information about the on screen menus within TitanNit and discriptions to the various
     9items and their functions aswell as helpfull information and tricks to get the most possible experience with your Receiver.
     10
     11Note: pictures in this area only apply to the default skin used in Titan.
     12If you do not see a specific menu item on the display please select the default skin from the menu as follows:
     13
     14 Press the __"Menu"__ button and select __"Settings"__ scroll down to __"Skin"__ and select the __"Default"__ Skin from the menu.
     15 The decoder will then reboot with the new selected __Default__ skin.
     16
     17[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Mainmenu.jpg)]][[br]]
     18
     19TitanNit is an easy to use GUI for Linux receivers. Using the default skin (Factory setting) all options, settings and help texts are displayed, so you have an overview of all functions and possible settings for customization.
     20
     21The newer Receiver types like Atemio520  have a help button on the remote where detailed help can be displayed on screen. Thus you do not need to refer to the manual for help. This help display will be optimized / enhanced in the future.
     22
     23Interface and operation contents
     24 please select a menu item from the GUI for more information
     25
     26 * ([#point3.1 Records and epg])
     27 * ([#point3.2 Media center])
     28 * ([#point3.3 Media player])
     29 * ([#point3.4 Extentions])
     30 * ([#point3.5 System])
     31 * ([#point3.6 Settings])
     32 * ([#point3.7 Information])
     33 * ([#point3.8 Standby-Power Off])
     34
     35[[br]]
     36[[br]]
     37----
     38'''Records and EPG''' [=#point3.1] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     39----
     40
     41
     42[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Recordsand_EPG.jpg)]][[br]]
     43
     44Records and Epg menu contains all the different views and search settings for the epg,
     45it also allows setup and personalization of timer recordings
     46 Please select a menu item for more specific information on that item.
     47 * ([wiki:EPG-Short-View#point3.1.1 EPG Short View])
     48 * ([wiki:Single-EPG#point3.1.2 Single EPG])
     49 * ([wiki:Multi-EPG#point3.1.3 Multi EPG])
     50 * ([wiki:Graphic-EPG#point3.1.4 Graphic EPG])
     51 * ([wiki:EPG-Search#point3.1.5 EPG Search])
     52 * ([wiki:Records#point3.1.6 Records])
     53
     54[[br]]
     55
     56----
     57'''3.2 Media Center''' [=#point3.2] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     58----
     59[[br]]
     60[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Media_Center.jpg)]][[br]]
     61
     62Media center contains all the different media players to play streams from local and online sources,
     63it also contains a file browser and internet browser for setting up pay streams and login details for online media.
     64 Please select a menu item for more specific information on that item.
     65
     66 * ([wiki:Audio-Player#point3.2.1 Audio Player])
     67 * ([wiki:Video-Player#point3.2.2 Video Player])
     68 * ([wiki:Picture-Player#point3.2.3 Picture Player])
     69 * ([wiki:Mediathek#point3.2.4 Mediathek (Online library)])
     70 * ([wiki:File-Browser#point3.2.5 File Browser])
     71 * ([wiki:Internet-Browser#point3.2.6 Internet Browser])
     72 * ([wiki:Weather#point3.2.7 Weather])
     73
     74
     75[[br]]
     76
     77''' information'''
     78
     79
     80Media Center It is a collection of media players intergrated in one place (able to stream local or the Internet based streams)
     81
     82''' Audio player '''
     83 * File List mode (display different possible views quickly, default, large, cover, full cover)
     84 * Play List mode (internal and external m3u Playlists)
     85 * Automatic integration of MediaDB with covers and ID3 tag info extracted from the mp3 file
     86 * Random mode (random)
     87 * Repeat mode (repeat)
     88 * Screen Saver (title text, scrolling images, jumping pictures, wallpapers)
     89 * Radio mode (m3u files can be played back over the Internet in all popular protocols rtmp, rtmpe, rts, rtp, mms, http)
     90 * All key formats supported via the installation of additional codec packs.
     91 * Auto play the next file
     92 * seek function (seek 1-3 10s 30s from 0.4 to 6 0.7 to 9 60s)
     93 * skip << >>
     94 * Mount image mode (iso, img, rar)
     95 * Various settings in the Settings Screen
     96 * Various sort options
     97
     98''' Video Player '''
     99 * File List mode (display different possible views quickly, default, large, cover, full cover)
     100 * Play List mode (internal and external m3u Playlists)
     101 * Automatic Intergration of MediaDB with cover, the background images and IMDB info downloaded from the Internet
     102 * Random mode (random)
     103 * Repeat mode (repeat)
     104 * Streaming mode (m3u files can be played back over the Internet in all popular protocols rtmp, rtmpe, rts, rtp, mms, http)
     105 * All key formats supported via the installation of additional codec packs.
     106 * Automatic Resume from the last position, or playback from the beginning.
     107 * Auto play the next file
     108 * Mount image mode (iso, img, rar)
     109 * DVD material (VIDEO_TS, usb, dvd drive ) but only if the corresponding Plugin is installed (DVDPlayer)
     110 * Various settings in the Settings Screen
     111 * Various sort options
     112 * seek function (seek 1-3 ,4-6 ,7-9 with the values ​​from the titan settings)
     113                *(seek on -pad up / down 10min left / right 1min)
     114 * In the file list (delete file additional menu, Imdb, ...) mode info button
     115 * In play mode - Red button - (additional menu Imdb, ...)
     116 * In Play Mode - Green button - (image ratio adjustable)
     117 * In Play Mode - Yellow button - (audio track selection)
     118 * In Play Mode - Blue button - (Screensaver adjustable)
     119 * In play mode - button text - (subtitles adjustable)
     120 * External Subtitle support (srt / sub files must have the same name as the video file)
     121 * Internal Subtitle Support (dvd / mkv files with integrated subtitles)
     122 * Manual IMDB lookup for [http://www.imdb.com/ Imdb / Cover]
     123 * Wallpapers adjustable (only in Full Cover interval / number)
     124
     125''' PicturePlayer '''
     126 * File List mode (display different possible views quickly, default, large, cover) (cover in that case means preview)
     127 * Play List mode (internal and external m3u Playlists pls)
     128 * Complete slide show with no waiting periods except the first file
     129 * Random mode (random)
     130 * Repeat mode (repeat)
     131 * Supported formats png / jpg
     132 * Mount image mode (iso, img, rar)
     133 * Various settings in the Settings Screen
     134 * Various sort options
     135 * Background radio selection
     136
     137''' MediaThek /online library '''
     138 * View images in groups of 2/6/12/24/30
     139 * [http://www.youtube.com/ Youtube] / [http://www.myvideo.de/ Myvideo] / [http://www.zdf.de/ZDFmediathek Zdf] / [http://www.ardmediathek.de/ Ard]
     140 * [http://rtl-now.rtl.de/ Rtl] / [http://www.rtl2.de/video/ Rtl2Now] / [http://www.superrtlnow.de/ SuperRtl] / [http://www.voxnow.de/ VoxNow] (with Pay-streams are hidden by default this can also be made ​​visible)
     141 * [http://www.netzkino.de Netzkino] / [http://www.tectime.tv/ DrDish] / [http://www.giga.de Giga]
     142 * [http://www.beeg.com Beeg] / [http://www.xvideos.com Xvideos] (xxx ) (blocked by child protection pin)
     143 * [https://gitorious.org/neutrino-mp/max10s-neutrino-mp/raw/e4fefb51121d7886b81227eb1215da049e1a729a:data/webtv/webtv.xml InternetTv] (Live Streams)
     144 * [http://dir.xiph.org/yp.xml InternetRadio] (Live Streams)
     145 * Support favourites
     146 * More providers are supported with the extension codec pack
     147 * Some Sites allow lokal strorage of their online streams
     148 * Memory Buffer adjustable for smooth, streaming
     149
     150'''File Browser '''
     151 * Copy data
     152 * Move data
     153 * Delete data
     154 * Rename data
     155 * Create folders
     156
     157''' Internet browser ''' (if installed)
     158 * From remote control unit
     159 * Support favourites
     160
     161'''Weather plugin '''
     162 * Select location
     163
     164----
     165'''3.3 Media player''' [=#point3.3] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     166
     167----
     168
     169
     170[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Media_player.jpg)]][[br]]
     171
     172Media player is a short file system browser for viewing local media files,
     173
     174
     175 '''Coloured Button's Functions'''
     176
     177 The __"Coloured Buttons"__ along the bottom of the display bring up additional menus and options with in the epg settings menu.
     178  Please see below for more info on the functions of these buttons:.
     179 
     180 ||'''Red Button: (Sorting)''' ||Set the sort method for the files listed in the file list display.||
     181 ||'''Green Button: (Select)''' ||Play the selected media file.||
     182 ||'''Yellow Button: (EPG)''' ||Show the EPG information on the current selected media file (If present)||
     183 ||'''Blue Button: (Sort)''' ||Set the sort method for the files listed in the file list display.||
     184 ||'''Info Button: (info)''' ||This will allow you to view online IMDB/TMDB information on the current selected media file.||
     185 
     186[[br]]
     187
     188----
     189'''3.4 Extentions''' [=#point3.4] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     190----
     191
     192[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Extentions.jpg)]][[br]]
     193
     194Extentions menu section contains all the available tools to personalize plugins
     195 Please select a menu item for more specific information on that item.
     196
     197 * ([wiki:Plugins#point3.4.1 Plugins])
     198 * ([wiki:Change-Feed#point3.4.2 Change Feed])
     199 * ([wiki:TPK-Upgrade#point3.4.3 TPK Upgrade])
     200 * ([wiki:TPK-Install#point3.4.4 TPK Install (Online)])
     201 * ([wiki:TPK-Tmp#point3.4.5 TPK Tmp (TMP)])
     202 * ([wiki:TPK-Media#point3.4.6 TPK Media (Media)])
     203 * ([wiki:TPK-Remove#point3.4.7 TPK Remove])
     204
     205[[br]]
     206
     207----
     208'''3.5 System''' [=#point3.5] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     209
     210----
     211
     212[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/System.jpg)]][[br]]
     213
     214The System menu section contains all the important settings to set up the Receiver Hardware and Software
     215 Please select a menu item for more specific information on that item.
     216
     217 * ([wiki:Channel-Service#point3.5.1 Channel Service])
     218 * ([wiki:Common-Interface#point3.5.2 Common Interface])
     219 * ([wiki:Smart-Card-Reader#point3.5.3 Smart Card Reader])
     220 * ([wiki:Network#point3.5.4 Network])
     221 * ([wiki:Hard-Disk#point3.5.5 Hard Disk])
     222 * ([wiki:VFDisplay#point3.5.6 VFDisplay])
     223 * ([wiki:System-Update#point3.5.7 System Update])
     224 * ([wiki:Backup#point3.5.8 Backup])
     225 * ([wiki:Settings-Backup-Restore#point3.5.9 Settings Backup Restore])
     226 * ([wiki:Receiver-Unlock#point3.5.10 Receiver Unlock])
     227
     228[[br]]
     229----
     230'''3.6 Settings''' [=#point3.6] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     231
     232----
     233
     234
     235
     236[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Settings.jpg)]][[br]]
     237
     238The Settings menu section contains all the Software settings of the Receiver,
     239within the menu you can personalize the appearance and various settings of the Interface
     240 Please select a menu item for more specific information on that item.
     241
     242 * ([wiki:AV-Settings#point3.6.1 AV Settings])
     243 * ([wiki:Language#point3.6.2 Language])
     244 * ([wiki:Timezone#point3.6.3 Timezone])
     245 * ([wiki:Red-Button#point3.6.4 Red Button])
     246 * ([wiki:Blue-Button#point3.6.5 Blue Button])
     247 * ([wiki:Media-Button#point3.6.6 Media Button])
     248 * ([wiki:Adjust#point3.6.7 System Settings])
     249 * ([wiki:Skin#point3.6.8 Skin])
     250 * ([wiki:Skin-Adjust#point3.6.9 Skin Settings])
     251 * ([wiki:Screensaver-Adjust#point3.6.10 Screensaver])
     252 * ([wiki:Timeshift-Settings#point3.6.11 Timeshift])
     253 * ([wiki:Record-Path#point3.6.12 Path for Recordings])
     254 * ([wiki:EPG-Settings#point3.6.13 EPG])
     255 * ([wiki:Child-Protection#point3.6.14 Parental Control])
     256 * ([wiki:Restore-Default-Settings#point3.6.15 Restore Factory Settings])
     257 * ([wiki:Video-Settings#point3.6.16 Video Settings])
     258 * ([wiki:Channel-Edit#point3.6.17 Channel Edit])
     259 * ([wiki:MediaDB-Settings#point3.6.18 MediaDB Settings])
     260 * ([wiki:Auto-Start-Settings#point3.6.19 Auto Start])
     261
     262[[br]]
     263
     264----
     265'''3.7 Information''' [=#point3.7] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     266
     267----
     268
     269[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Information.jpg)]][[br]]
     270
     271The Information menu section can list all the information of the Hardware, Software and stream info,
     272it also contains help and contact information.
     273Within the menu you can personalize the appearance and various settings of the Interface
     274 Please select a menu item for more specific information on that item.
     275
     276 * ([wiki:Service#point3.7.1 Service])
     277 * ([wiki:News-letter#point3.7.2 News letter])
     278 * ([wiki:About#point3.7.3 About])
     279 * ([wiki:Streaming#point3.7.4 Streaming])
     280 * ([wiki:Atemio-Hotline#point3.7.5 Atemio (Hotline)])
     281 * ([wiki:Titan-Changelog#point3.7.6 Titan Changelog])
     282 * ([wiki:Git-Changelog#point3.7.7 Git Changelog])
     283 * ([wiki:System-Info#point3.7.8 System Info])
     284 * ([wiki:Log#point3.7.9 Log])
     285
     286[[br]]
     287
     288----
     289'''3.8 Standby-Power Off''' [=#point3.8] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     290
     291----
     292
     293
     294[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Standby_Poweroff.jpg)]][[br]]
     295
     296The Standby/ Power Off contains settings related to power settings,
     297within the menu you can decide how and when the Receiver shuts down
     298 Please select a menu item for more specific information on that item.
     299
     300 ||'''Power-Off:''' ||The receiver shuts down completely (Deep Standby).||
     301 ||'''Standby:''' ||The receiver only shuts down the picture and volume. (Higher energy consumtion than in Deep Standby there for much faster booting time ~1Sek.). All functions of the WEB IF stay active.||
     302 ||'''Reboot:''' ||The receiver shuts down completely and reboots. (important for saving changes to the settings)||
     303 ||'''GUI-Restart:''' ||Only a reboot of the Titan software (faster) (changes to settings since last reboot/Power-Off are lost!).||
     304 ||'''([wiki:Power-Off-Timer Power Off Timer])''' ||Opens the Power Off timer menu to automatically switch the receiver to Power-Off or Standby at a specific time.||
     305[[br]]
  • wiki/pages/nl/Internet-Browser

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2>----
     3>'''3.2.6 Internet Browser''' [=#point3.2.6] ([wiki:Interface-Operation#point3.2 Media Center (Back)])([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4>
     5>
     6
     7>[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Media_Center-internet_browser.jpg)]][[BR]]
     8>
     9>internet browser is a netsurf based plugin to surf the net.
     10
     11[[br]]
  • wiki/pages/nl/Kernel

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2>----
     3>'''3.7.8.3 Kernel''' [=#point3.7.8.3] ([wiki:System-Info#point3.7.8 System Info (Back])
     4>
     5>
     6>[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Kernel.jpg)]][[br]]
     7>
     8Here you can view the kernel build info.
     9
     10[[br]]
     11
     12
     13[[br]]
  • wiki/pages/nl/Language

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2>----
     3>'''3.6.2 Language''' [=#point3.6.2] ([wiki:Interface-Operation#point3.6 Settings (Back)]) ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4>
     5>Menu Picture place holder:
     6>
     7>[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Language.jpg)]][[BR]]
     8>
     9here you can change your language.below is a current list of available languages.
     10if you change the language the decoder will automatically restart to apply the selected language settings.
     11
     12 * German
     13 * English
     14 * French
     15 * Greek
     16 * Italian
     17 * Polish
     18 * Russian
     19 * Dutch
     20 * Vietnamese
     21
     22[[br]]
  • wiki/pages/nl/Log

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2>----
     3>'''Log''' [=#point3.7.8] ([wiki:Interface-Operation#point3.7 Information (Back)])([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4>
     5>Menu Picture place holder:
     6>
     7>[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Information-log.jpg)]][[BR]]
     8>
     9> here you can view your error log.
     10
     11[[br]]
     12
     13
     14To Exit from Menu press the __"Exit"__ button.
     15 
     16[[br]]
     17----
     18
     19 '''Coloured Button's Functions"
     20
     21 The __"Coloured Buttons"__ along the bottom of the display bring up additional menus and options with in the epg settings menu.
     22 please see below for more info on the functions of these buttons:.
     23 
     24 ||'''Red Button: (Send)''' ||This will send the error log file to the titan development team.||
     25 ||'''Green Button: (DEL)''' ||this will delete the error log file.||
  • wiki/pages/nl/MTD

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2>----
     3>'''3.7.8.6.3 MTD''' [=#point3.7.8.6.3] ([WikiStart#point3.7.8.6 System Infos (Back)])
     4>
     5>
     6>[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/MTD.jpg)]][[br]]
     7>
     8Here you can view the detailed info on the raw flash partitions (MTD).
     9
     10[[br]]
     11
     12
     13[[br]]
  • wiki/pages/nl/Manual-Search

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2>----
     3>'''3.5.1.3 Manual Search''' [=#point3.5.1.3] ([wiki:Channel-Service#point3.5.1 Channel-Service (Back)]) ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4>
     5>
     6>[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Manual-Search.jpg)]][[br]]
     7>
     8Here you can proform a manual channel scan.
     9
     10[[br]]
     11
     12 ||'''Type of Scan''' ||The type of scan to proform.||
     13 ||'''Tuner''' ||Select the tunsr to scan with.||
     14 ||'''Satellite''' ||Select the satellite to scan.||
     15 ||'''ID''' ||??? .||
     16 ||'''System''' ||scan for hd or sd streams.||
     17 ||'''Frequency:''' ||select the frequency to scan.||
     18 ||'''Inversion:''' ||??? .||
     19 ||'''Symbolrate:''' ||select the signal rat to scan.||
     20 ||'''Polirisation''' ||scan for horozontal or vertical transponders.. ||
     21 ||'''FEC''' ||sel ect the forward error correction.||
     22 ||'''Scan:''' ||???.||
     23 ||'''Clear Before Scan:''' ||Select to clear channel data before scan.||
     24 ||'''Only Free to Air Services:''' ||During scan ignore pay tv services.||
     25 ||'''Blindscan:''' ||Scan for unknown satellite transponders.||
     26 ||'''Update channel Name''' ||???.||
     27 ||'''Entrys in Favourites'''  ||if scaned channels are found in current favourites list what should be done.||
     28 ||'''Remove Empty Favourites''' ||Remove favourites list if they have no channels in them.||
     29 ||'''Remove Unused Channels From Favourites'''  ||Remove channels from favourites that have ceased transmission.||
     30
     31 ''Note some of the above settings only show and are relavant in a specific __"Type of Scan"__''
     32
     33 
     34 To __"Store"__ the settings Exit from the EPG Settings Menu by pressing __"OK"__ or press __"Exit"__ to cancel changes.
     35
     36 '''Coloured Button's Functions'''
     37
     38 The __"Coloured Buttons"__ along the bottom of the display bring up additional menus and options with in the epg settings menu.
     39  Please see below for more info on the functions of these buttons:.
     40 
     41 ||'''Red Button: (Start scan)''' ||Start channel Scan with the selected settings.||
     42----
     43 '''After Scan Menu'''
     44----
     45[[br]]
     46
     47The __"Coloured Buttons"__ along the bottom of the display bring up additional menus and options after the scan hac sompleted menu.
     48  Please see below for more info on the functions of these buttons:.
     49 
     50 ||'''Red Button: (Save)''' ||Select a channel you wish to save and select the green button to save it in to the channel listing.||
     51 ||'''Green Button: (Save All)''' ||Store all channels in the channel listing.||
     52
     53
     54
  • wiki/pages/nl/Manufactures

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2----
     3'''13 Manufactures''' [=#point13] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4----
     5||= '''[http://www.atemio.de Atemio]''' =||
     6||= [[Image(http://i.imgur.com/3TwQr.jpg,400,link=http://www.atemio.de)]] =||
     7
     8New Zealand reseller for fortis clone ultraplus decoders [http://www.ultrapower.co.nz Ultrapower]
     9
     10'''SH4 Katherin'''   ([http://www.kathrein-gmbh.at kathrein homepage])
     11
     12'''SH4 Spark'''   ([http://www.spark-tv.com Spark homepage)]
     13
     14'''SH4 AB IPBox''' ([http://www.abipbox.com/ AB IPBox homepage])
     15
     16'''Mips Golden Interstar'''   ([http://www.golden-interstar.pl Golden Interstar homepage])
     17
     18'''SH4 Fortis'''  ([http://www.fortis.co.kr Fortis homepage])
     19 * New Zealand reseller for fortis clone ultraplus decoders [http://www.ultrapower.co.nz Ultrapower]
     20
     21[[br]]
     22[[br]]
  • wiki/pages/nl/Media-Button

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2>----
     3>'''3.6.6 Media Button''' [=#point3.6.6] ([wiki:Interface-Operation#point3.6 Settings (Back)])([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4>
     5>Menu Picture place holder:
     6>
     7>[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Media_Button.jpg)]][[BR]]
     8>
     9>here you can configure what happens with the press of the Media button
     10
     11
     12[[br]]
  • wiki/pages/nl/MediaDB-Settings

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2>----
     3>'''3.6.17 MediaDB Settings''' [=#point3.6.17] ([wiki:Interface-Operation#point3.6 Settings (Back)])([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4>
     5>Menu Picture place holder:
     6>
     7>[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/MediaDB_Settings.jpg)]][[BR]]
     8>
     9>Here you can change your media db settings.
     10
     11[[br]]
     12
     13 ||'''MediaDB Path''' ||Here you can edit the path where the MediaDB is stored.||
     14 ||'''Delete MediaDB Before Scan:''' ||here you can to select to clear the MediaDB before a scan.||
     15 ||'''Delete Unused Entrys Before Scan:''' ||Here you can delete MediaDB entries For items not used.||
     16 ||'''Update Entrys On Scan:''' ||Update entries in the MediaDB with updated information if present.||
     17 ||'''Backdrop Download Count:''' ||Select the amount of backdrops to download per Entry in the MediaDB.||
     18 ||'''Debug Modus:''' ||Select Debug mode to out put Media DB results logfile.||
     19 ||'''Create Thumb Picture:''' ||automatically Create Thumbnails for items in the MediaDB.||
     20 ||'''Create Record Picture:''' ||Automatically Creat Thumbnails for recordings.||
     21
     22To __"Store"__ the settings Exit from the EPG Settings Menu by pressing __"OK"__ or press __"Exit"__ to cancel changes.
     23
     24
  • wiki/pages/nl/Mediathek

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2>----
     3>'''3.2.4 Mediathek (Online library)''' [=#point3.2.4] ([wiki:Interface-Operation#point3.2 Media Center (Back)])([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4>
     5>Menu Picture place holder:
     6>
     7[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Tithek_main.jpg)]][[br]]
     8>
     9>Mediathek is the titan online media center to view various feeds from the internet
     10>such as utube etc...
     11
     12
     13[[br]]
  • wiki/pages/nl/Memory

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2>----
     3>'''3.7.8.3 Memory''' [=#point3.7.8.6.2] ([wiki:System-Info#point3.7.8.6 System Infos (Back)])
     4>
     5>
     6>[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Memory.jpg)]][[br]]
     7>
     8Here you can view the detailed Memory info.
     9
     10[[br]]
     11
     12
     13[[br]]
  • wiki/pages/nl/Module

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2>----
     3>'''3.7.8.6 Module''' [=#point3.7.8.6.4] ([wiki:System-Info#point3.7.8.6 System Infos (Back)])
     4>
     5>Menu Picture place holder:
     6>
     7>[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Module.jpg)]][[br]]
     8>
     9Here you can view the detailed loaded Module info.
     10
     11[[br]]
     12
     13
     14[[br]]
  • wiki/pages/nl/Mounts

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2>----
     3>'''3.7.8.4 Mounts''' [=#point3.7.8.4] ([wiki:System-Info#point3.7.8 System Info (Back])
     4>
     5>
     6>[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/DE/System-Info-Mounts.jpg)]][[br]]
     7>
     8Here you can view all mounted devices on the receiver.
     9
     10[[br]]
     11
     12
     13[[br]]
  • wiki/pages/nl/Multi-EPG

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2>----
     3>'''3.1.1 Multi EPG''' [=#point3.1.1] ([wiki:Interface-Operation#point3.1 Records and EPG(Back)]) ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4>
     5>Menu Picture place holder:
     6>
     7>[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Multi_EPG.jpg)]][[BR]]
     8>
     9Multi EPG is a small easy to read horozontal Multi Channel EPG.
     10
     11[[br]]
     12
     13 '''Coloured and Extra Button's Functions"
     14
     15 The __"Coloured and Extra Buttons"__ along the bottom of the display bring up additional menus and options with in the Single EPG menu.
     16 please see below for more info on the functions of these buttons:.
     17 
     18 ||'''Red Button: (Timer)''' ||This will bring up the recording timer menu to set up a timer.||
     19 ||'''0 key (EPG Search):''' ||This will search the EPG for text you specify and bring up a list of matches where you may press the red button to set up a timer.||
     20 ||'''Info Button: (Info)''' ||This will bring up the selected program's EPG info string.||
     21
     22
     23For information on setting up a timer Recording using the red button see ([wiki:Records Records]) for more info.
     24
     25For information on setting proforming an EPG search using the 0 Key see ([wiki:EPG-Search#point3.1.5 EPG Search]) for more info.
     26
  • wiki/pages/nl/Network

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2>----
     3>'''3.5.4 Network''' [=#point3.5.4] ([wiki:Interface-Operation#point3.5 System (Back)]) ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4>
     5>Menu Picture place holder:
     6>
     7>[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/system-Network.jpg)]][[BR]]
     8>
     9>
     10here you can set up your network interface and mounts.
     11please select a menu item for more information
     12[[br]]
     13
     14 * ([wiki:Adaptor-Settings#point3.5.4.1 Adaptor Settings])
     15 * ([wiki:WLAN-Settings#point3.5.4.2 WLAN Settings])
     16 * ([wiki:Network-Test#point3.5.4.3 Network Test])
     17 * ([wiki:Network-Restart#point3.5.4.4 Network Restart])
     18 * ([wiki:Network-Browser#point3.5.4.5 Network Browser])
     19 * ([wiki:HTTP-Settings#point3.5.4.6 HTTP Settings])
     20 * ([wiki:DYNDNS-Settings#point3.5.4.7 DYNDNS Settings])
     21
     22[[br]]
     23
  • wiki/pages/nl/Network-Browser

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2>----
     3>'''3.5.4.5 Network Browser''' [=#point3.5.4.5] ([WikiStart#point3.5.1 network (Back])
     4>
     5>
     6>[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Network-Browser.jpg)]][[br]]
     7>
     8Here you can setup network shares.
     9
     10[[br]]
     11
     12To __"Store"__ the settings Exit from the Menu by pressing __"OK"__ or press __"Exit"__ to cancel changes.
     13 
     14[[br]]
     15----
     16
     17 '''Coloured Button's Functions"
     18
     19 The __"Coloured Buttons"__ along the bottom of the display bring up additional menus and options with in the epg settings menu.
     20 please see below for more info on the functions of these buttons:.
     21 
     22 ||'''Red Button: (Add)''' ||This will bring up the add network share.||
     23 ||'''Green Button: (Edit)''' ||this will edit the currently selected network mount.||
     24 ||'''Yellow Button: (DEL)''' ||The will Delete the currently selected network share.||
     25 ||'''Blue Button: (Search)''' ||This will search the surrent subnet mask for available network shares.||
     26 ||'''Menu Button: (Auth Settings)''' ||this will allow you to edit the current password and user name.||
     27
  • wiki/pages/nl/Network-Restart

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2>----
     3>'''3.5.4.4 Network Restart''' [=#point3.5.4.4] ([wiki:System-Info#point3.5.1 network (Back])
     4>
     5>
     6[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Network-Restart.jpg)]]
     7>
     8Here you can Restart your network interface.
     9
     10[[br]]
     11
     12 press the __"Ok"__ button to restart the network interface, Press __"Exit"__ to Cancel.
  • wiki/pages/nl/Network-Test

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2>----
     3>'''3.5.4.3 Network Test''' [=#point3.5.4.3] ([wiki:Network#point3.5.1 network (Back])
     4>
     5>
     6>[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Network-Test.jpg)]][[br]]
     7>
     8Here you can check your network interface.
     9
     10[[br]]
     11
     12 To Exit from the network test menu by pressing the __"Exit"__ button.
     13 
     14[[br]]
     15----
     16
     17 '''Coloured Button's Functions"
     18
     19 The __"Coloured Buttons"__ along the bottom of the display bring up additional menus and options with in the epg settings menu.
     20 please see below for more info on the functions of these buttons:.
     21 
     22 ||'''Red Button: (TEST)''' ||This will proform a network test.||
  • wiki/pages/nl/News-letter

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2>----
     3>'''3.7.2 News letter''' [=#point3.7.2] ([wiki:Interface-Operation#point3.7 Information (Back)])([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4>
     5>Menu Picture place holder:
     6>
     7>[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Newsletter.jpg)]][[BR]]
     8>
     9> here you can view news from the titan team.
     10
     11[[br]]
     12
     13Select a newsitem with the D-pad and press __"ok"__ to view it.
     14
     15To Exit from the Menu by pressing the __"Exit"__ button.
     16
  • wiki/pages/nl/Picture-Player

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2>----
     3>'''3.2.3 Picture Player''' [=#point3.2.3] ([wiki:Interface-Operation#point3.2 Media Center (Back)])([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4>
     5>
     6>[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Media_center-Picture-Player.jpg)]][[BR]]
     7>
     8picture player is where you can view pictures and set up slideshows.
     9
     10[[br]]
     11
     12----
     13 '''Coloured Button's Functions'''
     14
     15 The __"Coloured Buttons"__ along the bottom of the display bring up additional menus and options with in the epg settings menu.
     16 please see below for more info on the functions of these buttons:.
     17 
     18 ||'''Red Button: (Sorting)''' ||Set the sort method for the files listed in the file list display.||
     19 ||'''Green Button: (Filelist-Mode)''' ||Switch between filelist mode and playlist mode.||
     20 ||'''Yellow Button: (Random)''' ||select random play mode.||
     21 ||'''Blue Button: (Repeat)''' ||Select Repeat play mode.||
     22 ||'''Menu Button: (Menu)''' ||This will show an advanced settings menu for the media player see below for more info on the functions contained with in this menu.||
     23
     24----
     25 '''Advanced Media Player Menu'''
     26
     27[[br]]
     28
     29 Picture:
     30 ||'''Sort:''' ||Set the sort method for the files listed in the file list display.||
     31 ||'''View:''' ||Switch between filelist mode and playlist mode.||
     32 ||'''Sound:''' ||Set the sort method for the files listed in the file list display.||
     33 ||'''interval:''' ||Switch between filelist mode and playlist mode.||
     34 ||'''Show Pic Title:''' ||Auto scan MediaDb in Background.||
     35 ||'''Pic Denom Mode:''' ||Set the sort method for the files listed in the file list display.||
     36 ||'''Pic Quality:''' ||Switch between filelist mode and playlist mode.||
     37 ||'''Pic HW Decoder:''' ||Auto scan MediaDb in Background.||
     38 ||'''Default Directory:''' ||Set the default directory to display when the media player opens.||
     39 ||'''Use Last Directory:''' ||open the last used directory when the media player opens.||
     40
     41
     42 '''Coloured Button's Functions'''
     43
     44
     45 ||'''Red Button: (Network)''' ||???||
     46 ||'''Green Button: (Edit)''' ||???||
     47
     48----
  • wiki/pages/nl/Plugins

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2>----
     3>'''Plugins''' [=#point3.4.1] ([wiki:Interface-Operation#point3.4 Extentions (Back)]) ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4>
     5>Menu Picture place holder:
     6>
     7>[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Plugins.jpg)]][[BR]]
     8>
     9
     10
     11In this menu you can run your plugins start and stop them.
     12
     13to start a plugin select it with the D-pad and press __"ok"__
     14
     15'''Coloured Button's Functions"
     16
     17 The __"Coloured Buttons"__ along the bottom of the display bring up additional menus and options with in the epg settings menu.
     18 please see below for more info on the functions of these buttons:.
     19 
     20 '''Red Button''' This button unloads the currently selected plugin it can not be restarted until the box is rebooted.
     21
     22 '''Blue Button''' This button restarts the currently selected plugin if it is not loaded or running.
     23[[br]]
     24
     25
     26
  • wiki/pages/nl/Plugins-Bootlogos

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2----
     3'''10.2 Bootlogos''' [=#point10.2] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4----
     5
     6Bootlogos are the default logo that shows during startup and the loading cycle of your Receiver.
     7You may select and install these from the online extentions.
     8
     9||= '''Bikergirl''' =||= '''Blueskulls''' =||= '''Cityflash''' =||= '''Enigmalinux''' =||= '''Fantasygirl2''' =||= '''Fantasygirl''' =||
     10||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source/bootlogos_bikergirl_0_1/preview/prev.png,link=source:/ipk/source/bootlogos_bikergirl_0_1/_path_/etc/boot)]] =||=[[Image(source:/ipk/source/bootlogos_blueskull_0_1/preview/prev.png,link=source:/ipk/source/bootlogos_blueskull_0_1/_path_/etc/boot)]] =||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source/bootlogos_cityflash_0_1/preview/prev.png,link=source:/ipk/source/bootlogos_cityflash_0_1/_path_/etc/boot)]] =||=[[Image(source:/ipk/source/bootlogos_enigmalinux_0_1/preview/prev.png,link=source:/ipk/source/bootlogos_enigmalinux_0_1/_path_/etc/boot)]] =||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source/bootlogos_fantasygirl2_0_1/preview/prev.png,link=source:/ipk/source/bootlogos_fantasygirl2_0_1/_path_/etc/boot)]] =||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source/bootlogos_fantasygirl_0_1/preview/prev.png,link=source:/ipk/source/bootlogos_fantasygirl_0_1/_path_/etc/boot)]]
     11=||
     12[[br]]
     13||= '''Firelady''' =||= '''Fireskull''' =||= '''Footballgirls''' =||= '''Ghostrider''' =||= '''Giantgirl''' =||= '''Iceage2scrapufs910''' =||
     14||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source/bootlogos_firelady_0_1/preview/prev.png,link=source:/ipk/source/bootlogos_firelady_0_1/_path_/etc/boot)]] =||=[[Image(source:/ipk/source/bootlogos_fireskull_0_1/preview/prev.png,link=source:/ipk/source/bootlogos_fireskull_0_1/_path_/etc/boot)]] =||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source/bootlogos_footballgirls_0_1/preview/prev.png,link=source:/ipk/source/screensaver_beach_1.0/_path_/usr/local/share/titan/saver/beach)]] =||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source/bootlogos_ghostrider_0_1/preview/prev.png,link=source:/ipk/source/bootlogos_ghostrider_0_1/_path_/etc/boot)]] =||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source/bootlogos_giantgirl_0_1/preview/prev.png,link=source:/ipk/source/bootlogos_giantgirl_0_1/_path_/etc/boot)]] =||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source/bootlogos_iceage2scrapufs910_0_1/preview/prev.png,link=source:/ipk/source/bootlogos_iceage2scrapufs910_0_1/_path_/etc/boot)]]
     15=||
     16[[br]]
     17||= '''Linuxgirl''' =||= '''Planets''' =||= '''Thegrimreaper''' =||= '''Zombie''' =||= '''TitanNit 1''' =||= '''TitanNit 2''' =||
     18||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source/bootlogos_linuxgirl_0_1/preview/prev.png,link=source:/ipk/source/bootlogos_linuxgirl_0_1/_path_/etc/boot)]] =||=[[Image(source:/ipk/source/bootlogos_planets_0_1/preview/prev.png,link=source:/ipk/source/bootlogos_planets_0_1/_path_/etc/boot)]] =||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source/bootlogos_thegrimreaper_0_1/preview/prev.png,link=source:/ipk/source/bootlogos_thegrimreaper_0_1/_path_/etc/boot)]] =||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source/bootlogos_zombie_0_1/preview/prev.png,link=source:/ipk/source/bootlogos_zombie_0_1/_path_/etc/boot)]] =||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source/bootlogos_TitanNit_0_1/preview/prev.png,link=source:/ipk/source/bootlogos_TitanNit_0_1/_path_/etc/boot)]] =||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source/bootlogos_TitanNit_0_2/preview/prev.png,link=source:/ipk/source/bootlogos_TitanNit_0_2/_path_/etc/boot)]]
     19=||
     20[[br]]
     21||= '''TitanNit 3''' =||= '''TitanNit 4''' =||
     22||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source/bootlogos_TitanNit_0_3/preview/prev.png,link=source:/ipk/source/bootlogos_TitanNit_0_3/_path_/etc/boot)]] =||=[[Image(source:/ipk/source/bootlogos_TitanNit_0_4/preview/prev.png,link=source:/ipk/source/bootlogos_TitanNit_0_4/_path_/etc/boot)]]
     23=||
     24[[br]]
     25([#point10.2 Top of Page])
  • wiki/pages/nl/Plugins-Browser

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2----
     3'''10.3 Browser''' [=#point10.3] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4----
     5
     6TitanNit offers a plugin called '''Netsurf''' that allows you to browse the Internet from your receiver. Detailed information will follow.
     7
     8[[Image(source:/ipk/source.sh4/browser_netsurf/preview/prev.png)]]
  • wiki/pages/nl/Plugins-Channel-Lists

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2'''10.6 Channel Lists''' [=#point10.6] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     3
     4Channel list's are provided by other users.[[br]]
     5They contain complete satellite listings aswell as sorted favourites to make it[[br]]
     6easier for you to use on your receiver.
     7[[br]]
     8A list of the current channel lists provided are:
     9
     10Satellite:
     11 * Hotbird 13.0
     12 * Astra 19.2
     13 * Astra 28.2
     14
     15Cable:
     16 * Cable germany
     17 * Cable BW
     18 * Cable Unitymedia
     19 * Primacom Cable
     20
     21If you wish to provide your own satellite configurations please post them in the [http://aaf-digital.info AAF forum].
     22----
     23||= '''Default Kabel''' =||= '''Default Sat''' =||= '''Matze70 Neues Design''' =||= '''Matze70 Sat''' =||
     24||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source/settings_cableD_1_0/preview/prev.png)]] =||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source/settings_default_sat_1_0/preview/prev.png)]] =||= [[Image(source:ipk/source/settings_matze70neueDesign_sat19_1_0/preview/prev.png)]] =||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source/settings_matze70_sat_1_0/preview/prev.png)]] =||
     25[[br]]
     26||= '''Bulldog 3xsat''' =||= '''Sofa Kabel-BW''' =||= '''Uljanow Sat''' =||= '''Unitymedia Cable''' =||
     27||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source/settings_bulldog_3xSat_1_0/preview/prev.png)]] =||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source/settings_sofa_cableBW_1_0/preview/prev.png)]] =||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source/settings_uljanow_1sat_1_0/preview/prev.png)]] =||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source/settings_unitymedia_cable/preview/prev.png)]] =||
     28[[br]]
     29||= '''Primacom Kabel''' =||= '''Settings Eutelsat 36.0''' =||= '''Kabel Deutschland UH-Kreis''' =||= '''Sat Astra ORF''' =||
     30||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source/settings_primacom_cable_1_0/preview/prev.png)]] =||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source/settings_ser6_eutelsat36_1_0/preview/prev.png)]] =||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source/settings_paule_cable_1_0/preview/prev.png)]] =||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source/settings_orf_1xsat_1_0/preview/prev.png)]] =||
     31[[br]]
     32||= '''Kabelplus ORF''' =||= '''Astra 19.2 KabelD''' =||= '''Bulldog 2xsat''' =||= '''Bulldog 1xsat''' =||
     33||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source/settings_kabelplus_cable_1_0/preview/prev.png)]] =||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source/settings_default_all_2_0/preview/prev.png)]] =||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source/settings_bulldog_2xSat_1_0/preview/prev.png)]] =||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source/settings_bulldog_1xsat_1_0/preview/prev.png)]] =||
     34[[br]]
     35||= '''SAT/Cable 19.2 13.0 KabelD''' =||
     36||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source/settings_andy_2xSat_KabelD_1_0/preview/prev.png)]] =||
     37[#point10.6 Top of Page]
  • wiki/pages/nl/Plugins-Contents

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2----
     3'''10.1 Plugins''' [=#point10] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4
     5
     6----
     7
     8== Plugin contents ==
     9
     10This list contains a list of the current online plugins available in TitanNit, please see [wiki:Interface-Operation#point3.4 3.4 Extentions] for more information on how to install and manage these plugins.
     11
     12please select an item below to view the available plugins in the selected area.
     13
     14{{{#!div style="width: 1100px; margin: auto"
     15 {{{#!table style="border: none"
     16  {{{#!td align=center valign=top style="border: none; font-size: 115%"
     17  {{{#!div style="float: left"
     18[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/Common/Icons/Plugins-Contents/Screensavers.png,align=left,link=[wiki:Plugins-Screensavers#point10.1 10.1 Screensavers])]]
     19  }}}
     20  '''[wiki:Plugins-Screensavers#point10.1 10.1 Screensavers]'''[[br]]
     21  {{{#!div style="float: left
     22This section contains information on the various screen savers available in TitanNit.
     23  }}}
     24  }}}
     25  {{{#!td align=center valign=top style="border: none; font-size: 115%"
     26  {{{#!div style="float: left"
     27[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/Common/Icons/Plugins-Contents/Bootlogos.png,align=left,link=[wiki:Plugins-Bootlogos#point110.2 10.2 Bootlogos])]]
     28  }}}
     29  '''[wiki:Plugins-Bootlogos#point110.2 10.2 Bootlogos]'''[[br]]
     30  {{{#!div style="float: left
     31This section contains information on the various Bootlogos available in TitanNit.
     32  }}}
     33  }}}
     34  {{{#!td align=center valign=top style="border: none; font-size: 115%"
     35  {{{#!div style="float: left"
     36[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/Common/Icons/Plugins-Contents/browser.png,align=left,link=[wiki:Plugins-Browser#point10.3 10.3 Browser])]]
     37  }}}
     38  '''[wiki:Plugins-Browser#point10.3 10.3 Browser]'''[[br]]
     39  {{{#!div style="float: left
     40This section contains information on the various web browsers available in TitanNit.
     41  }}}
     42  }}}
     43  |----
     44  {{{#!td align=center valign=top style="border: none; font-size: 115%"
     45  {{{#!div style="float: left"
     46[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/Common/Icons/Plugins-Contents/Info_news.png,align=left,link=[wiki:Plugins-Infos#point10.5 10.5 info-news])]]
     47  }}}
     48  '''[wiki:Plugins-Infos#point10.5 10.5 info-news]'''[[br]]
     49  {{{#!div style="float: left
     50This section contains information on the info and news pluggins screen savers available in TitanNit.
     51  }}}
     52  }}}
     53  {{{#!td align=center valign=top style="border: none; font-size: 115%"
     54  {{{#!div style="float: left"
     55[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/Common/Icons/Plugins-Contents/Channel_Lists.png,align=left,link=[wiki:Plugins-Channel-Lists#point10.6 10.6 Channel Lists])]]
     56  }}}
     57  '''[wiki:Plugins-Channel-Lists#point10.6 10.6 Channel Lists]'''[[br]]
     58  {{{#!div style="float: left
     59This section contains default channel list for different services available in TitanNit.
     60  }}}
     61  }}}
     62  {{{#!td align=center valign=top style="border: none; font-size: 115%"
     63  {{{#!div style="float: left"
     64[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/Common/Icons/Plugins-Contents/Keymaps.png,align=left,link=[wiki:Plugins-Keymaps#point10.7 10.7 Keymaps])]]
     65  }}}
     66  '''[wiki:Plugins-Keymaps#point10.7 10.7 Keymaps]'''[[br]]
     67  {{{#!div style="float: left
     68This section contains information on the various Keymaps available in TitanNit.
     69  }}}
     70  }}}
     71  |----
     72  {{{#!td align=center valign=top style="border: none; font-size: 115%"
     73  {{{#!div style="float: left"
     74[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/Common/Icons/Plugins-Contents/LCD_Pearl_Skins.png,align=left,link=[wiki:Plugins-LcdPearlSkins#point10.8 10.8 LCD Pearl Skins])]]
     75  }}}
     76  '''[wiki:Plugins-LcdPearlSkins#point10.8 10.8 LCD Pearl Skins]'''[[br]]
     77 {{{#!div style="float: left
     78This section contains information on the various lcd skins available in TitanNit with an addon pearl lcd module.
     79  }}}
     80  }}}
     81  {{{#!td align=center valign=top style="border: none; font-size: 115%"
     82  {{{#!div style="float: left"
     83[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/Common/Icons/Plugins-Contents/LCD_Samsung_Skins.png,align=left,link=[wiki:Plugins-LcdSamsungSkins#point10.9 10.9 LCD Samsung Skins])]]
     84  }}}
     85  '''[wiki:Plugins-LcdSamsungSkins#point10.9 10.9 LCD Samsung Skins]'''[[br]]
     86   {{{#!div style="float: left
     87This section contains information on the various skins available in TitanNit with a samsung display tablet extension device.
     88  }}}
     89  }}}
     90  {{{#!td align=center valign=top style="border: none; font-size: 115%"
     91  {{{#!div style="float: left"
     92[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/Common/Icons/Plugins-Contents/Network.png,align=left,link=[wiki:Plugins-Network#point10.10 10.10 Network])]]
     93  }}}
     94  '''[wiki:Plugins-Network#point10.10 10.10 Network]'''[[br]]
     95  {{{#!div style="float: left
     96This section contains information on the various network plugins and extensions available in TitanNit.
     97  }}}
     98  }}}
     99  |----
     100  {{{#!td align=center valign=top style="border: none; font-size: 115%"
     101  {{{#!div style="float: left"
     102[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/Common/Icons/Plugins-Contents/player.png,align=left,link=[wiki:Plugins-Player#point10.10 10.10 Player])]]
     103  }}}
     104  '''[wiki:Plugins-Player#point10.10 10.10 Player]'''[[br]]
     105  {{{#!div style="float: left
     106This section contains information on the various media players and media renderers available in TitanNit.
     107  }}}
     108  }}}
     109  {{{#!td align=center valign=top style="border: none; font-size: 115%"
     110  {{{#!div style="float: left"
     111[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/Common/Icons/Plugins-Contents/fonts.png,align=left,link=[wiki:Plugins-Fonts#point10.11 10.11 Fonts])]]
     112  }}}
     113  '''[wiki:Plugins-Fonts#point10.11 10.11 Fonts]'''[[br]]
     114  {{{#!div style="float: left
     115This section contains information on the various gui fonts available in TitanNit.
     116  }}}
     117  }}}
     118  {{{#!td align=center valign=top style="border: none; font-size: 115%"
     119  {{{#!div style="float: left"
     120[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/Common/Icons/Plugins-Contents/Station_Logos.png,align=left,link=[wiki:Plugins-station-logos#point10.12 10.12 station logos])]]
     121  }}}
     122  '''[wiki:Plugins-station-logos#point10.12 10.12 station logos]'''[[br]]
     123  {{{#!div style="float: left
     124This section contains information on the various pre configures icon sets available in TitanNit for various TV services.
     125  }}}
     126  }}}
     127|----
     128  {{{#!td align=center valign=top style="border: none; font-size: 115%"
     129  {{{#!div style="float: left"
     130[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/Common/Icons/Plugins-Contents/Skins.png,align=left,link=[wiki:Plugins-Skins#point10.13 10.13 Skins])]]
     131  }}}
     132  '''[wiki:Plugins-Skins#point10.13 10.13 Skins]'''[[br]]
     133  {{{#!div style="float: left
     134This section contains information on the various Gui Skins available in TitanNit.
     135  }}}
     136  }}}
     137  {{{#!td align=center valign=top style="border: none; font-size: 115%"
     138  {{{#!div style="float: left"
     139[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/Common/Icons/Plugins-Contents/Games.png,align=left,link=[wiki:Plugins-Games#point10.14 10.14 Games])]]
     140  }}}
     141  '''[wiki:Plugins-Games#point10.14 10.14 Games]'''[[br]]
     142  {{{#!div style="float: left
     143This section contains information on the various games available in TitanNit.
     144  }}}
     145  }}}
     146  {{{#!td align=center valign=top style="border: none; font-size: 115%"
     147  {{{#!div style="float: left"
     148[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/Common/Icons/Plugins-Contents/Tools.png,align=left,link=[wiki:Plugins-Tools#point10.15 10.15 Tools])]]
     149  }}}
     150  '''[wiki:Plugins-Tools#point10.15 10.15 Tools]'''[[br]]
     151  {{{#!div style="float: left
     152This section contains information on the various system pluggins and tools available in TitanNit.
     153  }}}
     154  }}}
     155|----
     156  {{{#!td align=center valign=top style="border: none; font-size: 115%"
     157  {{{#!div style="float: left"
     158[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/Common/Icons/Plugins-Contents/WLan.png,align=left,link=[wiki:Plugins-Wlan#point10.16 10.16 Wlan])]]
     159  }}}
     160  '''[wiki:Plugins-Wlan#point10.16 10.16 Wlan]'''[[br]]
     161   {{{#!div style="float: left
     162This section contains information on the various wereless lan drivers available in TitanNit.
     163  }}}
     164  }}}
     165|----
     166}}}
     167}}}
  • wiki/pages/nl/Plugins-Emus

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2----
     3'''10.4 Emus''' [=#point10.4] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 contents]) ([Wikistart#point0 Main Page])
     4----
     5
     6Emulators are plugins that enable the use and connection to online pay tv services and providers to enable pay TV Reception.
     7
     8Ther are many emulators available from to support the connection to different pay TV services.
     9
     10Please note that in some countrys and providers this form of on line subscription is illegal please contact your pay TV provider or local authority for more information in this area, please see our [wiki:Disclaimer#point17 disclaimer] on services.
     11
     12This section is provided for for use only with providers who allow such use with their pay tv service.
     13
     14[[Image(source:/ipk/source.sh4/emus_camd3_3_902/preview/prev.png)]]
     15[[Image(source:/ipk/source.sh4/emus_gbox_800/preview/prev.png)]]
     16[[Image(source:/ipk/source.sh4/emus_gbox_806/preview/prev.png)]]
     17[[Image(source:/ipk/source.sh4/emus_incubus_1_22/preview/prev.png)]]
     18[[Image(source:/ipk/source.sh4/emus_mbox0.6_0010/preview/prev.png)]]
     19[[Image(source:/ipk/source.sh4/emus_mgcamd_1_35/preview/prev.png)]]
     20[[Image(source:/ipk/source.sh4/emus_mgcamd_1_38a/preview/prev.png)]]
     21[[Image(source:/ipk/source.sh4/emus_newcs/preview/prev.png)]]
     22[[Image(source:/ipk/source.sh4/emus_oscam_4736v13/preview/prev.png)]]
     23[[Image(source:/ipk/source.sh4/emus_oscam_7209/preview/prev.png)]]
     24[[Image(source:/ipk/source.sh4/emus_oscam_8755/preview/prev.png)]]
     25[[Image(source:/ipk/source.sh4/emus_oscam_8755small/preview/prev.png)]]
     26[[Image(source:/ipk/source.sh4/emus_oscam_8933/preview/prev.png)]]
     27[[Image(source:/ipk/source.sh4/emus_oscam_nightly/preview/prev.png)]]
     28[[Image(source:/ipk/source.sh4/emus_oscam_spezial/preview/prev.png)]]
  • wiki/pages/nl/Plugins-Fonts

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2----
     3'''10.12 Fonts''' [=#point10.12] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4----
     5
     6Should you not like the graphical presentation of titan or its looks[[br]]
     7you may change it by installing the fonts (numbered left to right):[[br]]
     8[[br]]
     9'''1. actionmanitalic'''[[br]]
     10'''2. alpharomanieg'''[[BR]]
     11'''3. croissant'''[[BR]]
     12'''4. default'''[[BR]]
     13[[Image(source:/ipk/source/fonts_actionmanitalic_1_0/preview/prev.png)]]
     14[[Image(source:/ipk/source/fonts_alpharomanieg_1_0/preview/prev.png)]]
     15[[Image(source:/ipk/source/fonts_croissant_1_0/preview/prev.png)]]
     16[[Image(source:/ipk/source/fonts_default_1_0/preview/prev.png)]][[br]][[br]]
     17[[br]]
     18'''5. digifaceregular'''[[BR]]
     19'''6. goodtime'''[[BR]]
     20'''7. ihatecomicsans'''[[BR]]
     21'''8. lydianbolditalicbt'''[[BR]]
     22[[Image(source:/ipk/source/fonts_digifaceregular_1_0/preview/prev.png)]]
     23[[Image(source:/ipk/source/fonts_goodtime_1_0/preview/prev.png)]]
     24[[Image(source:/ipk/source/fonts_ihatecomicsans_1_0/preview/prev.png)]]
     25[[Image(source:/ipk/source/fonts_lydianbolditalicbt_1_0/preview/prev.png)]][[br]]
     26[[br]]
     27'''9. mightyzeocaps'''[[BR]]
     28'''10. monoglyceridedemibold'''[[BR]]
     29'''11. newgothicbt'''[[BR]]
     30'''12. paddingtonbold'''[[br]]
     31[[Image(source:/ipk/source/fonts_mightyzeocaps_1_0/preview/prev.png)]]
     32[[Image(source:/ipk/source/fonts_monoglyceridedemibold_1_0/preview/prev.png)]]
     33[[Image(source:/ipk/source/fonts_newgothicbt_1_0/preview/prev.png)]]
     34[[Image(source:/ipk/source/fonts_paddingtonbold_1_0/preview/prev.png)]][[br]][[br]]
     35[[br]]
     36'''13. ploverbold'''[[br]]
     37[[Image(source:/ipk/source/fonts_ploverbold_1_0/preview/prev.png)]]
     38
  • wiki/pages/nl/Plugins-Games

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2----
     3'''10.15 Games''' [=#point10.15] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4----
     5
     6This section contains Games that can be installed from the Online Extensions.[[br]]
     7[[br]]
     8||= '''1. catcatch''' =||= '''2. Tic Tac Toe (wins3)'''
     9||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source.sh4/games_catcatch/preview/prev.png)]] =||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source.sh4/games_wins3/preview/prev.png)]] =||
  • wiki/pages/nl/Plugins-Infos

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2'''10.5 Infos''' [=#point10.5] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     3
     4Currently TitanNit offers multiple info plugins that allow the receiver to browse[[br]]
     5the net or local sources for information/news. Further information on these plugins will follow in near future.
     6
     7 '''IMDB''' enables detailed viewing of media info to selected media.
     8[[Image(source:/ipk/source.sh4/infos_imdb/preview/prev.png)]]
     9
     10
     11 '''IMDBAPI''' enables detailed viewing of media info to selected media.
     12[[Image(source:/ipk/source.sh4/infos_imdbapi/preview/prev.png)]]
     13
     14
     15 '''News''' enables online viewing of actual news and current events.
     16[[Image(source:/ipk/source.sh4/infos_news/preview/prev.png)]]
     17
     18
     19 '''Stock''' enables online viewing of stock reports.
     20[[Image(source:/ipk/source.sh4/infos_stock/preview/prev.png)]]
     21
     22
     23 '''Streaminfo''' shows details of the current running stream.
     24[[Image(source:/ipk/source.sh4/infos_streaminfo/preview/prev.png)]]
     25
     26
     27 '''TMDB''' enables detailed viewing of media info to selected media.
     28[[Image(source:/ipk/source.sh4/infos_tmdb/preview/prev.png)]]
     29
     30
     31 '''Weather''' allows you to view weather details for selecteted locations from online sources.
     32[[Image(source:/ipk/source.sh4/infos_weather/preview/prev.png)]]
  • wiki/pages/nl/Plugins-Keymaps

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2----
     3'''10.7 Keymaps''' [=#point10.7] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4----
     5
     6Using this plugin you can map your remote control commands to[[br]]
     7the known '''Neutrino''' keymap functionality.[[br]]
     8[[Image(source:/ipk/source.sh4/keymaps_neutrino/preview/prev.png)]]
  • wiki/pages/nl/Plugins-LcdPearlSkins

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2----
     3'''10.8 LCD Pearl Skins''' ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4----
     5
     6'''Pearl LCD''' is a project that allows a user to connect a Pearl USB LCD dotmatric display[[br]]
     7to a compatible receiver. It allows displaying of channel logos, channel name, time and timebar[[br]]
     8(for remaining time of the running program).
     9 
     10The display is full skinable and you may personalize it for your own comfort.
     11
     12Please see the '''open source project''' for more information. Detailed information will follow.
     13 
     14
     15[[Image(source:/ipk/source/lcdpearlskins_atemio_style/preview/prev.png)]]
     16[[Image(source:/ipk/source/lcdpearlskins_blau_mit_picons/preview/prev.png)]]
     17[[Image(source:/ipk/source/lcdpearlskins_mrp/preview/prev.png)]][[br]]
     18[[Image(source:/ipk/source/lcdpearlskins_only_picon/preview/prev.png)]]
     19[[Image(source:/ipk/source/lcdpearlskins_picon_gross_schwarz/preview/prev.png)]]
     20[[Image(source:/ipk/source/lcdpearlskins_schwarz_ohne_picons/preview/prev.png)]]
  • wiki/pages/nl/Plugins-LcdSamsungSkins

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2'''10.9 LCD Samsung Skins''' [=#point10.9] ([wiki:English-Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     3
     4'''Samsung LCD''' is a project that allows a user to connect a[[br]]
     5Samsung USB LCD dotmatric display to a compatible receiver. It allows displaying of[[br]]
     6channel logos, channel name, time and timebar (for remaining time of the running program).
     7[[br]]
     8The display is full skinable and you may personalize it for your own comfort.
     9[[br]]
     10Please see the '''open source project''' for more information. Detailed information will follow.
     11[[br]]
     12
     13[[Image(source:/ipk/source/lcdsamsungskins_channel_Analoguhr/preview/prev.png)]]
     14[[Image(source:/ipk/source/lcdsamsungskins_channel_Digitaluhr_gelb/preview/prev.png)]]
     15[[Image(source:/ipk/source/lcdsamsungskins_channel_Digitaluhr_Trikots/preview/prev.png)]][[br]]
     16[[Image(source:/ipk/source/lcdsamsungskins_Digitaluhr_blau/preview/prev.png)]]
     17[[Image(source:/ipk/source/lcdsamsungskins_Holzuhr_Standby/preview/prev.png)]]
  • wiki/pages/nl/Plugins-Network

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2----
     3'''10.10 Network''' [=#point10.10] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4
     5The Plugins in this section allow you to extend the communication capabillty of your receiver.
     6These plugins can be downloaded from the online extensions browser.
     7 
     8
     9
     10'''DLNA''' is a server extension that allows you to stream video or audio files[[br]]
     11directly to other DLNA capable digital devices attached in your home network.
     12[[br]][[Image(source:/ipk/source.sh4/network_dlna/preview/prev.png)]]
     13
     14'''Facebook''' allows you login and use Facebook from your receiver.
     15[[br]][[Image(source:/ipk/source.sh4/network_facebook/preview/prev.png)]]
     16
     17'''e2webserv''' allows a connection from an E2 client to your TitanNit receiver and allows[[br]]
     18you to control your receiver, stream channels and recordings and allows managemant of[[br]]
     19timers (for recordings). Thanks to this plugin it is possible to connect from an iOS[[br]]
     20App, a PC or Raspberry Pi with the '''XBMC''' software (VU+).[[br]]
     21It is reported to run with dreaMote Lite, dreaMote, e2RemoteHD[[br]]
     22and Dreambox Live for iOS aswell as XBMC for Windows7 and Raspberry Pi.
     23[[br]][[Image(source:/ipk/source.sh4/networklib_e2webserv/preview/prev.png)]]
     24
     25'''libpack''' is a compilation of drivers that extend the[[br]]
     26communication capability of your receiver.
     27[[br]][[Image(source:/ipk/source.sh4/networklib_libpack/preview/prev.png)]]
     28
     29'''libsmbclient''' is a plugin for low Memory receivers. This[[br]]
     30plugin has to be installed to enable smbfs setup and usage.
     31[[br]][[Image(source:/ipk/source.sh4/networklib_libsmbclient_3_0_28b/preview/prev.png)]]
     32
     33'''networkbrowser''' allows you to use your remote control to[[br]]
     34mount available NFS and CIFSsharepoints inside your local connected network. 
     35[[br]][[Image(source:/ipk/source.sh4/network_networkbrowser/preview/prev.png)]]
     36
     37'''OpenVPN''' allows a server client VPN connection. To use this plugin you have[[br]]
     38to edit the configuration files and should have sophisticated knowledge in netwrok setup.
     39[[br]][[Image(source:/ipk/source.sh4/network_openvpn/preview/prev.png)]]
     40
     41'''Samba''' is needed to include your receiver as a Windows networkdrive.[[br]]
     42Using the plugin your receiver is a Samba server.
     43[[br]][[Image(source:/ipk/source.sh4/network_samba/preview/prev.png)]]
     44
     45'''SmbClient (Win7)''' is a network browser extention for better compatibility with windows 7.
     46[[br]][[Image(source:/ipk/source.sh4/networklib_smbclient/preview/prev.png)]]
     47
     48'''xupnpd - eXtensible UPnP agent''' is a server extension that allows you to stream video, audio files[[br]]
     49and live tv from a free tuner from your receiver directly to other DLNA capable digital[[br]]
     50devices attached in your home network.
     51
     52What can the xupnpd DLNA server? [[BR]]
     53
     54At every start of the current playlists bouquets and images are generated (takes a few seconds), then then starts xupnpd.
     55 Is a tuner free, then to the desired channel is zapped. Single tuner boxes should be in standby. In principle, the same behavior as the stream via the web interface.
     56 There is still the possibility to enable the option "Allow switching by Live Stream" in the web interface settings. Then xupnpd has priority. Note that switches to the station!
     57 
     58Operation:
     59Call the plugin in Extensions -> Additional Programs
     60Autostart yes / no or manual start or stop with green or red
     61
     62[[br]][[Image(source:/ipk/source.sh4/network_xupnpd/preview/prev.png)]]
     63
  • wiki/pages/nl/Plugins-Player

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2----
     3'''10.11 Player''' [=#point10.11] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4----
     5
     6'''Players''' are plugins to enable the playback of further file formats and sources.[[br]]
     7below is a list of available plugins:[[br]]
     8
     9----
     10
     11{{{#!th rowspan=0 align=left style="border: none"
     12[[Image(source:/ipk/source.sh4/playersnp_codecpack/preview/prev.png,nolink)]]
     13}}}
     14|----------------
     15{{{#!td style="border: none"
     16 '''CodecPack'''
     17
     18 will enable playback of more Online media file formats such as: (flac ogg mp3 avi dat divx flv mkv m4v mp4 mov mpg mpeg mts m2ts trp ts vdr vob wmv wma wav rm ra)
     19}}}
     20[[BR]]
     21
     22{{{#!th rowspan=0 align=left style="border: none"
     23[[Image(source:/ipk/source.sh4/playersnp_dtsdownmix/preview/prev.png,link=source:/ipk/source.sh4/playersnp_dtsdownmix/_path_/bin)]]
     24}}}
     25|----------------
     26{{{#!td style="border: none"
     27 '''DtsDownMix'''
     28
     29 to recode DTS Digital Audio to Stereo output.
     30}}}
     31[[BR]]
     32
     33{{{#!th rowspan=0 align=left style="border: none"
     34[[Image(source:/ipk/source.sh4/playersnp_dvdplayer/preview/prev.png,link=source:/titan/plugins/dvdplayer)]]
     35}}}
     36|----------------
     37{{{#!td style="border: none"
     38 '''DVD-Player'''
     39
     40 will enable playback VOB file format to play back ripped DVD content.
     41}}}
     42[[BR]]
     43
     44{{{#!th rowspan=0 align=left style="border: none"
     45[[Image(source:/ipk/source.sh4/players_gmediarender/preview/prev.png,link=source:/titan/plugins/gmediarender)]]
     46}}}
     47|----------------
     48{{{#!td style="border: none"
     49 '''GmediaRender'''
     50
     51 * GmediaRender is a __[http://de.wikipedia.org/wiki/Digital_Living_Network_Alliance Digital Media Renderer]__ (DMR / DLNA-Renderer), which allows the __PC__ /__Mobile __[http://de.wikipedia.org/wiki/Digital_Living_Network_Alliance Digital Media Controller] (DMC / DLNA-Control) to stream __Audio__ / __Video__ and __Picture__ files from a [http://de.wikipedia.org/wiki/Digital_Living_Network_Alliance Digital Media Server] (DMS / DLNA-SERVER) to your reciever.
     52 
     53 * __Windows__
     54   * In Windows Explorer context menu __Right-click__ on Files> Play To> __[http://gmrender.nongnu.org/ GmediaRender]__.
     55   * Windows Media Player is a __[http://de.wikipedia.org/wiki/Digital_Living_Network_Alliance DMS / DMP / DMS]__ and can control all __[http://de.wikipedia.org/wiki/Digital_Living_Network_Alliance DMS]__  present in the network and the media offered to __[http://gmrender.nongnu.org/ GmediaRender]__
     56
     57 * __mobile (Android)__
     58   * for __[http://de.wikipedia.org/wiki/Android_%28Betriebssystem%29 Android]__ mobile there is a few __[http://de.wikipedia.org/wiki/Digital_Living_Network_Alliance DMC]__ __Apps__: __[https://play.google.com/store/apps/details?id=tv.airwire AirWire]__ / __[http://m.downloadatoz.com/apps/com.skifta.android.app,68844/download.html Skifta]__, these __Apps__ can control data from__[http://de.wikipedia.org/wiki/Digital_Living_Network_Alliance DMS]__ and the __[http://gmrender.nongnu.org/ GmediaRender]__  to control your reciever to display media on tyour TV.
     59
     60   * A very nice feature the  __[http://xupnpd.org/t/ Xupnp Server]__ is able to display your channel list and recordings by Playlist that you can then easily pass directly to the renderer or cell phone.
     61[[Image(source:/titan/skins/gmediarender/skin/background.jpg,link=http://static.androidnext.de/dlna-schema-450x500.png, 480px, align=right,link=http://www.aaf-digital.info/forum/forum.php)]]
     62
     63 * some __[http://de.wikipedia.org/wiki/Digital_Living_Network_Alliance DMS]__ can display and share __[http://de.wikipedia.org/wiki/Digital_Living_Network_Alliance DLNA]__ network such as:
     64   * External media / Online Channels (__[https://www.youtube.com/ Youtube]__ / __[https://www.ted.com/ Ted]__ / __[http://www.vimeo.com/‎ Vimeo]__)
     65   * Cloud Storage Hoster (__[https://www.google.com/drive/ Google Drive]__ / __[https://www.dropbox.com/ Dropbox]__ / __[https://onedrive.live.com/ OneDrive]__ / __[https://disk.yandex.com/ Yandex.Disk]__ / __[https://www.box.com/ Box]__)
     66   * Webcam Dienste oder im Netzwerk befindliche Überwachungs Cams.
     67
     68 * Possibil playback from your  __[http://de.wikipedia.org/wiki/Digital_Living_Network_Alliance DMC]__ from (__[https://play.google.com/store/apps/details?id=tv.airwire AirWire]__ / __[http://m.downloadatoz.com/apps/com.skifta.android.app,68844/download.html Skifta]__ / __[http://allconnectapp.com/ AllConnect]__ / __[http://bubblesoftapps.com/bubbleupnpserver/ BubbleDlna]__)
     69   *  (some __[http://de.wikipedia.org/wiki/Digital_Living_Network_Alliance DMS]__ can control the media playback with such features as volume up/down/ Pause / Play / Stop / fast forward/ reverse)
     70
     71 * __preview__
     72   * __AirWire__ __[https://play.google.com/store/apps/details?id=tv.airwire&hl=de about]__ / __[http://airwire.tv/en/site/users help]__ / __[http://airwire.tv/ Home]__
     73   * __BubbleDlna__ __[http://bubblesoftapps.com/bubbleupnpserver/#what_is_bubble_upnp_server About]__ / __[http://bubblesoftapps.com/bubbleupnpserver/#faq help]__ / __[http://bubblesoftapps.com/bubbleupnpserver/ Home]__
     74   * __Allconnect__ __[http://allconnectapp.com/presskit/ About]__ / __[http://allconnectapp.com/faq/ Help]__ / __[http://allconnectapp.com/faq/ Home]__
     75
     76 In general __[http://de.wikipedia.org/wiki/Digital_Living_Network_Alliance DLNA]__ is a very complex network DLNA software with almost no restrictions in its operation.
     77
     78
     79
     80}}}
     81[[BR]]
     82
     83{{{#!th rowspan=0 align=left style="border: none"
     84[[Image(source:/ipk/source.sh4/playersnp_hbbtv/preview/prev.png,link=source:/titan/plugins/hbbtv)]]
     85}}}
     86|----------------
     87{{{#!td style="border: none"
     88 '''HbbTv'''
     89
     90 is a media client connect to HBB-TV Online media.
     91}}}
     92[[BR]]
     93
     94{{{#!th rowspan=0 align=left style="border: none"
     95[[Image(source:/ipk/source.sh4/players_mc/preview/prev.png,link=source:/titan/plugins/mc)]]
     96}}}
     97|----------------
     98{{{#!td style="border: none"
     99 '''MediaCenter'''
     100
     101 [wiki:Interface-Operation#point3.2 Media center] to playback picutres, audio and video files
     102}}}
     103[[BR]]
     104
     105{{{#!th rowspan=0 align=left style="border: none"
     106[[Image(source:/ipk/source.sh4/players_tithek/preview/prev.png,link=source:/titan/plugins/tithek)]]
     107}}}
     108|----------------
     109{{{#!td style="border: none"
     110 '''Tithek'''
     111
     112Titannit online hoseted media (online library).
     113}}}
     114[[BR]]
     115
     116{{{#!th rowspan=0 align=left style="border: none"
     117[[Image(source:/ipk/source.sh4/players_tmc/preview/prev.png,link=source:/titan/plugins/tmc)]]
     118}}}
     119|----------------
     120{{{#!td style="border: none"
     121 '''Tmc'''
     122
     123 Tmc - to playback movies from a local connected Network device
     124}}}
     125[[BR]]
     126
     127{{{#!th rowspan=0 align=left style="border: none"
     128[[Image(source:/ipk/source/players_foldericons_1_0/preview/prev.png,link=source:/ipk/source/players_foldericons_1_0/_path_/usr/local/share/titan/imdbfolder)]]
     129}}}
     130|----------------
     131{{{#!td style="border: none"
     132 '''FolderIcons'''
     133
     134to add a graphical icon to your media folders.
     135}}}
     136[[BR]]
  • wiki/pages/nl/Plugins-Screensavers

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2----
     3'''10.1 Screensavers''' [=#point10.1] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4----
     5
     6Screensavers show during the playback of music or when the reciever is not in use to protect the tv screen from dammage from long term static images.
     7You may select and install screensavers from the online extentions.
     8
     9||= '''Default''' =||= '''Animation Kidds''' =||= '''Beach''' =||= '''Bikes Motorcycles''' =||= '''Brands Logos''' =||= '''Cars''' =||
     10||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source/screensaver_default_1_0/preview/prev.png,link=source:/ipk/source/screensaver_default_1_0/_path_/usr/local/share/titan/saver/default)]] =||=[[Image(source:/ipk/source/screensaver_animation.kidds_1.0/preview/prev.png,link=source:/ipk/source/screensaver_animation.kidds_1.0/_path_/usr/local/share/titan/saver/animation.kidds)]] =||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source/screensaver_beach_1.0/preview/prev.png,link=source:/ipk/source/screensaver_beach_1.0/_path_/usr/local/share/titan/saver/beach)]] =||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source/screensaver_bikes.motorcycles_1.0/preview/prev.png,link=source:/ipk/source/screensaver_bikes.motorcycles_1.0/_path_/usr/local/share/titan/saver/bikes.motorcycles)]] =||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source/screensaver_brands.logos_1.0/preview/prev.png,link=source:/ipk/source/screensaver_brands.logos_1.0/_path_/usr/local/share/titan/saver/brands.logos)]] =||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source/screensaver_cars_1.0/preview/prev.png,link=source:/ipk/source/screensaver_cars_1.0/_path_/usr/local/share/titan/saver/cars)]]
     11=||
     12[[br]]
     13||= '''Celebrations''' =||= '''Celebrities''' =||= '''Christmas''' =||= '''Creative Graphics''' =||= '''Cute''' =||= '''Digital Universe''' =||
     14||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source/screensaver_celebrations_1.0/preview/prev.png,link=source:/ipk/source/screensaver_celebrations_1.0/_path_/usr/local/share/titan/saver/celebrations)]] =||=[[Image(source:/ipk/source/screensaver_celebrities_1.0/preview/prev.png,link=source:/ipk/source/screensaver_celebrities_1.0/_path_/usr/local/share/titan/saver/celebrities)]] =||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source/screensaver_christmas_1.0/preview/prev.png,link=source:/ipk/source/screensaver_christmas_1.0/_path_/usr/local/share/titan/saver/christmas)]] =||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source/screensaver_creative.graphics_1.0/preview/prev.png,link=source:/ipk/source/screensaver_creative.graphics_1.0/_path_/usr/local/share/titan/saver/creative.graphics)]] =||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source/screensaver_cute_1.0/preview/prev.png,link=source:/ipk/source/screensaver_cute_1.0/_path_/usr/local/share/titan/saver/cute)]] =||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source/screensaver_digital.universe_1.0/preview/prev.png,link=source:/ipk/source/screensaver_digital.universe_1.0/_path_/usr/local/share/titan/saver/digital.universe)]]
     15[[br]]
     16||= '''Dreamy Fantasy''' =||= '''Eisriesenwelt''' =||= '''Fantasy Girls''' =||= '''Fc Bayern''' =||= '''Flowers''' =||= '''Games''' =||
     17||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source/screensaver_dreamy.fantasy_1.0/preview/prev.png,link=source:/ipk/source/screensaver_dreamy.fantasy_1.0/_path_/usr/local/share/titan/saver/dreamy.fantasy)]] =||=[[Image(source:/ipk/source/screensaver_eisriesenwelt_1_0/preview/prev.png,link=source:/ipk/source/screensaver_eisriesenwelt_1_0/_path_/usr/local/share/titan/saver/eisriesenwelt)]] =||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source/screensaver_fantasy.girls_1.0/preview/prev.png,link=source:/ipk/source/screensaver_fantasy.girls_1.0/_path_/usr/local/share/titan/saver/fantasy.girls)]] =||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source/screensaver_fcbayern_1_0/preview/prev.png,link=source:/ipk/source/screensaver_fcbayern_1_0/_path_/usr/local/share/titan/saver/fcbayern)]] =||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source/screensaver_flowers_1.0/preview/prev.png,link=source:/ipk/source/screensaver_flowers_1.0/_path_/usr/local/share/titan/saver/flowers)]] =||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source/screensaver_games_1.0/preview/prev.png,link=source:/ipk/source/screensaver_games_1.0/_path_/usr/local/share/titan/saver/games)]]
     18[[br]]
     19||= '''HDR Pictures''' =||= '''Hotgirls 1''' =||= '''Hotgirls 2''' =||= '''Inspirational''' =||= '''Love''' =||= '''Movies''' =||
     20||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source/screensaver_HDR-Pictures_1.0/preview/prev.png,link=source:/ipk/source/screensaver_HDR-Pictures_1.0/_path_/usr/local/share/titan/saver/HDR-Pictures)]] =||=[[Image(source:/ipk/source/screensaver_hotgirls_1_0/preview/prev.png,link=source:/ipk/source/screensaver_hotgirls_1_0/_path_/usr/local/share/titan/saver/hotgirls)]] =||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source/screensaver_hotgirls_2.0/preview/prev.png,link=source:/ipk/source/screensaver_hotgirls_2.0/_path_/usr/local/share/titan/saver/hotgirls_2)]] =||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source/screensaver_inspirational_1.0/preview/prev.png,link=source:/ipk/source/screensaver_inspirational_1.0/_path_/usr/local/share/titan/saver/inspirational)]] =||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source/screensaver_love_1.0/preview/prev.png,link=source:/ipk/source/screensaver_love_1.0/_path_/usr/local/share/titan/saver/love)]] =||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source/screensaver_movies_1.0/preview/prev.png,link=source:/ipk/source/screensaver_movies_1.0/_path_/usr/local/share/titan/saver/movies)]]
     21[[br]]
     22||= '''Nature Landscape''' =||= '''Others''' =||= '''Photography''' =||= '''Planes''' =||= '''Radio''' =||= '''Sports''' =||
     23||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source/screensaver_nature.landscape_1.0/preview/prev.png,link=source:/ipk/source/screensaver_nature.landscape_1.0/_path_/usr/local/share/titan/saver/nature.landscape)]] =||=[[Image(source:/ipk/source/screensaver_others_1.0/preview/prev.png,link=source:/ipk/source/screensaver_others_1.0/_path_/usr/local/share/titan/saver/others)]] =||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source/screensaver_photography_1.0/preview/prev.png,link=source:/ipk/source/screensaver_photography_1.0/_path_/usr/local/share/titan/saver/photography)]] =||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source/screensaver_planes_1.0/preview/prev.png,link=source:/ipk/source/screensaver_planes_1.0/_path_/usr/local/share/titan/saver/planes)]] =||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source/screensaver_radio_1.0/preview/prev.png,link=source:/ipk/source/screensaver_radio_1.0/_path_/usr/local/share/titan/saver/radio)]] =||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source/screensaver_sports_1.0/preview/prev.png,link=source:/ipk/source/screensaver_sports_1.0/_path_/usr/local/share/titan/saver/sports)]]
     24[[br]]
     25||= '''Travel World''' =||
     26||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source/screensaver_travel.world_1.0/preview/prev.png,link=source:/ipk/source/screensaver_travel.world_1.0/_path_/usr/local/share/titan/saver/travel.world)]] =||
     27[[br]]
     28([#point10.1 Top of Pge])
  • wiki/pages/nl/Plugins-Skins

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2----
     3'''10.14 Skins''' [=#point10.14] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4----
     5
     6Installing one of the follwing skins will change the look of the titan interface you may select and install skins from the online extentions.[[br]]
     7
     8||= '''0Acht5Zehn''' =||= '''0Acht5Zehnblack''' =||= '''0Acht5Zehnwhite''' =||= '''Cool''' =||= '''CoolMiniTV''' =||= '''Default''' =||
     9||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source/skins_0Acht5Zehn/preview/prev.png,link=source:/ipk/source/skins_0Acht5Zehn/_path_/usr/local/share/titan/skin/0Acht5Zehn)]] =||=[[Image(source:/ipk/source/skins_0Acht5Zehnblack/preview/prev.png,link=source:/ipk/source/skins_0Acht5Zehnblack/_path_/usr/local/share/titan/skin/0Acht5Zehn_black)]] =||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source/skins_0Acht5Zehnwhite/preview/prev.png,link=source:/ipk/source/skins_0Acht5Zehnwhite/_path_/usr/local/share/titan/skin/0Acht5Zehn_white)]] =||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source/skins_cool/preview/prev.png,link=source:/ipk/source/skins_cool/_path_/usr/local/share/titan/skin/cool)]] =||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source/skins_coolMiniTV/preview/prev.png,link=source:/ipk/source/skins_coolMiniTV/_path_/usr/local/share/titan/skin/coolMiniTV)]] =||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source/skinsdefault_default/preview/prev.png,link=source:/ipk/source/skinsdefault_default/_path_/usr/local/share/titan/skin/default)]]
     10=||
     11[[br]]
     12||= '''Default no MiniTV''' =||= '''Megastyle-Blue''' =||= '''Megastyle-Blue-MiniTV''' =||= '''MegaStyle-Grey''' =||= '''MegaStyle-Grey-MiniTV''' =||= '''MetrixHD''' =||
     13||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source/skinsdefault_defnominitv/preview/prev.png,link=source:/ipk/source/skinsdefault_defnominitv/_path_/usr/local/share/titan/skin/defnominitv)]]||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source/skins_MegaStyle_blue/preview/prev.png,link=source:/ipk/source/skins_MegaStyle_blue/_path_/usr/local/share/titan/skin/MegaStyle-Blue)]] =||=[[Image(source:/ipk/source/skins_MegaStyle_blue_MiniTV/preview/prev.png,link=source:/ipk/source/skins_MegaStyle_blue_MiniTV/_path_/usr/local/share/titan/skin/MegaStyle-Blue-MiniTV)]] =||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source/skins_MegaStyle_grey/preview/prev.png,link=source:/ipk/source/skins_MegaStyle_grey/_path_/usr/local/share/titan/skin/MegaStyle-Grey)]] =||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source/skins_MegaStyle_grey_MiniTV/preview/prev.png,link=source:/ipk/source/skins_MegaStyle_grey_MiniTV/_path_/usr/local/share/titan/skin/MegaStyle-Grey-MiniTV)]] =||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source/skins_MetrixHD/preview/prev.png,link=source:/ipk/source/skins_MetrixHD/_path_/usr/local/share/titan/skin/MetrixHD)]]
     14=||
     15[[br]]
     16||= '''NoGfx''' =||= '''NoGfx Grey''' =||= '''SmartTV''' =||= '''tobayer01''' =||= '''ufs912''' =||
     17||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source/skins_nogfx/preview/prev.png,link=source:/ipk/source/skins_nogfx/_path_/usr/local/share/titan/skin/nogfx)]]=||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source/skins_nogfx_grey/preview/prev.png,link=source:/ipk/source/skins_nogfx_grey/_path_/usr/local/share/titan/skin/nogfx_grey)]] =||=[[Image(source:/ipk/source/skins_smartTV/preview/prev.png,link=source:/ipk/source/skins_smartTV/_path_/usr/local/share/titan/skin/smartTV)]] =||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source/skins_tobayer01/preview/prev.png,link=source:/ipk/source/skins_tobayer01/_path_/usr/local/share/titan/skin/tobayer01)]] =||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source/skins_ufs912/preview/prev.png,link=source:/ipk/source/skins_ufs912/_path_/usr/local/share/titan/skin/ufs912)]]
     18=||
     19
     20([#point10.14 Top of Page])
  • wiki/pages/nl/Plugins-Tools

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2----
     3'''10.16 Tools''' [=#point10.16] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4----
     5
     6
     7{{{#!th rowspan=0 align=left style="border: none"
     8[[Image(source:/ipk/source.sh4/tools_autotimer/preview/prev.png)]] 
     9}}}
     10|----------------
     11{{{#!td style="border: none"
     12 '''Auto timer'''
     13
     14 Set repeat timers for timer recordings to automatically record[[br]]
     15 the same program in future (i.e. serials) or automatic channel switch
     16
     17}}}
     18([#point10.16 Top of Page])
     19[[BR]]
     20
     21{{{#!th rowspan=0 align=left style="border: none"
     22[[Image(source:/ipk/source.sh4/tools_callmonitor/preview/prev.png)]]
     23}}}
     24|----------------
     25{{{#!td style="border: none"
     26 '''Callmonitor'''
     27
     28 Incoming / outgoing phone calls are displayed on the screen.
     29
     30}}}
     31([#point10.16 Top of Page])
     32[[BR]]
     33
     34{{{#!th rowspan=0 align=left style="border: none"
     35[[Image(source:/ipk/source.sh4/tools_filemanager/preview/prev.png)]]
     36}}}
     37|----------------
     38{{{#!td style="border: none"
     39 '''Filemanager'''
     40
     41 Access your files on the receiver and external drives[[br]]
     42 move/copy/delete them.
     43
     44}}}
     45([#point10.16 Top of Page])
     46[[BR]]
     47
     48{{{#!th rowspan=0 align=left style="border: none"
     49[[Image(source:/ipk/source.sh4/tools_IP-Kamera/preview/prev.png)]]
     50}}}
     51|----------------
     52{{{#!td style="border: none"
     53 '''IP Camera'''
     54
     55 An in-network IP camera can be displayed on the screen.[[br]]
     56 Movement of the camera is possible if the camera supports it.
     57
     58}}}
     59([#point10.16 Top of Page])
     60[[BR]]
     61
     62{{{#!th style="border: none" rowspan=0 align=left
     63[[Image(source:/ipk/source.sh4/tools_lcdpearl1/preview/prev.png)]]
     64}}}
     65|----------------
     66{{{#!td style="border: none"
     67 '''LCD-Pearl'''
     68
     69 Viewing EPG info, station logos, on the small external Pearl-USB picture frame.[[br]]
     70 Additional Skin informationcan be found at ([wiki:Plugins-LcdPearlSkins#point110.8 10.8 LCD Pearl Skins]).
     71}}}
     72([#point10.16 Top of Page])
     73[[BR]]
     74
     75
     76{{{#!th rowspan=0 align=left style="border: none"
     77[[Image(source:/ipk/source.sh4/tools_lcdsamsung/preview/prev.png)]]
     78}}}
     79|----------------
     80{{{#!td style="border: none"
     81  '''LCD-Samsung'''
     82
     83 Viewing EPG info, station logos, on the small external Samsung-USB picture frame.[[br]]
     84 Additional Skin informationcan be found at ([wiki:Plugins-LcdSamsungSkins#point110.9 10.9 LCD Samsung Skins]).
     85
     86}}}
     87([#point10.16 Top of Page])
     88[[BR]]
     89
     90{{{#!th rowspan=0 align=left style="border: none"
     91[[Image(source:/ipk/source.sh4/tools_optimize/preview/prev.png)]]
     92}}}
     93|----------------
     94{{{#!td style="border: none"
     95 '''Optimize'''[[BR]][[BR]]
     96 A tool to optimize the channel lists in TitanNit. Redundant transmitters[[br]]
     97 and transponders can be removed here.[[br]]
     98 The speed when scrolling through the channel list increases.
     99
     100}}}
     101([#point10.16 Top of Page])
     102[[BR]]
     103
     104
     105{{{#!th rowspan=0 align=left style="border: none"
     106[[Image(source:/ipk/source.sh4/tools_parted/preview/prev.png)]]
     107}}}
     108|----------------
     109{{{#!td style="border: none"
     110 '''Parted'''
     111
     112 Parted is neccessary to format a Harddisk with a capacity larger 2TB. After installing[[br]]
     113 the plugin it is active so you can setup your Haiddisk straight away.
     114
     115}}}
     116([#point10.16 Top of Page])
     117[[BR]]
     118
     119
     120{{{#!th rowspan=0 align=left style="border: none"
     121[[Image(source:/ipk/source.sh4/tools_PermanentTime/preview/prev.png)]]
     122}}}
     123|----------------
     124{{{#!td style="border: none"
     125 '''Permanent Time'''
     126
     127 Activate it and the time is shown permanently on your screen[[br]]
     128 until you call up the function again to deactivate it.
     129
     130}}}
     131([#point10.16 Top of Page])
     132[[BR]]
     133
     134{{{#!th rowspan=0 align=left style="border: none"
     135[[Image(source:/ipk/source.sh4/tools_tsschnitt/preview/prev.png)]]
     136}}}
     137|----------------
     138{{{#!td style="border: none"
     139 '''Record cut'''
     140
     141 With 'Record cut' You can edit the recordings in titan by cutting the beginning and end.[[br]]
     142 Start the desired movie with the internal player, at the desired start-point and End-point[[br]]
     143 press the -0- Key on your Remote Control. To view the set markers press -5- on your Remote Control.[[br]]
     144 'Record cut' is now started and by pressing the -Green- button select the movie and with the -Blue- button[[br]]
     145 By pressing the -Yeelow- button the cutting process can be executed in the backbround.[[br]]
     146 After the Process has finished an information is shown on the TV-screen.[[br]]
     147 The Process can be watched or abborted by pressing the -Red- button.
     148
     149}}}
     150([#point10.16 Top of Page])
     151[[BR]]
     152
     153{{{#!th rowspan=0 align=left style="border: none"
     154[[Image(source:/ipk/source.sh4/tools_rgui/preview/prev.png)]]
     155}}}
     156|----------------
     157{{{#!td style="border: none"
     158 '''RGUI'''
     159
     160 With Rgui you can access a different Titan Receiver.[[br]]
     161 You may also access the TV Program of the other receiver.[[br]]
     162 Streaming between both receivers is also possible.
     163}}}
     164([#point10.16 Top of Page])
     165[[BR]]
     166
     167{{{#!th rowspan=0 align=left style="border: none"
     168[[Image(source:/ipk/source.sh4/tools_scriptexec/preview/prev.png)]]
     169}}}
     170|----------------
     171{{{#!td style="border: none"
     172 '''Scriptexec'''
     173
     174 A small plugin to execute code on the receiver.
     175
     176}}}
     177([#point10.16 Top of Page])
     178[[BR]]
     179
     180{{{#!th rowspan=0 align=left style="border: none"
     181[[Image(source:/ipk/source.sh4/tools_stopifnotused/preview/prev.png)]]
     182}}}
     183|----------------
     184{{{#!td style="border: none"
     185 '''stop if not used'''
     186
     187 Your receiver is automatically turned off after a set time should no further Key be pressed.[[br]]
     188
     189 Autostart = yes / no - Time to Action (min) = 30/60/90/120/180/240 - Action = standby / off
     190
     191}}}
     192([#point10.16 Top of Page])
     193[[BR]]
     194
     195
     196{{{#!th rowspan=0 align=left style="border: none"
     197[[Image(source:/ipk/source.sh4/tools_usbreset/preview/prev.png)]]
     198}}}
     199|----------------
     200{{{#!td style="border: none"
     201 '''USB Reset'''
     202
     203 Attached USB devices are re-read.
     204}}}
     205([#point10.16 Top of Page])
     206[[BR]]
     207
     208{{{#!th rowspan=0 align=left style="border: none"
     209[[Image(source:/ipk/source.sh4/tools_zapback/preview/prev.png)]]
     210}}}
     211|----------------
     212{{{#!td style="border: none"
     213 '''Zapback'''
     214
     215 Zapback will after a given time automatically switch back to a pre-set channel .
     216
     217}}}
     218([#point10.16 Top of Page])
  • wiki/pages/nl/Plugins-Wlan

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2----
     3'''10.17 WLAN Module''' [=#point10.17] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4----
     5
     6TitanNit is compatable with several usb Wireless lan devices below is a list of compatable wireless modules chipset's:
     7
     8 * Realtek RTL8192SE (802.11N)
     9 * Realtek RTL8712U (802.11N)
     10 * Ralink RT2870STA (802.11N)
     11 * Ralink RT3070STA (802.11N)
     12 * Ralink RT5370STA (802.11N)
     13
     14Drivers can be installed from any of the above devices from the online extentions ([wiki:TPK-Install#point3.4.4 TPK Install (Online)])
     15
     16||= '''WLAN 8192 driver''' =||= '''WLAN Driver 8172u''' =||= '''WLAN Driver rt2870sta''' =||= '''WLAN Driver rt3070sta''' =||= '''WLAN Driver rt5370sta''' =||
     17||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source.sh4/wlan_8192cu/preview/prev.png)]] =||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source.sh4/wlan_8712u/preview/prev.png)]] =||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source.sh4/wlan_rt2870sta/preview/prev.png)]] =||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source.sh4/wlan_rt3070sta/preview/prev.png)]] =||= [[Image(source:/ipk/source.sh4/wlan_rt5370sta/preview/prev.png)]] =||
  • wiki/pages/nl/Plugins-station-logos

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2----
     3'''10.13 Channel logos (Picons)''' [=#point10.13] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4----
     5'''picons_transparent'''
     6
     7[[Image(source:/ipk/source/picons_transparent_SAT13_0/preview/prev.png)]]
     8[[Image(source:/ipk/source/picons_transparent_SAT19_2/preview/prev.png)]]
     9[[Image(source:/ipk/source/picons_transparent_SAT23_5/preview/prev.png)]]
     10[[Image(source:/ipk/source/picons_transparent_SAT28_2/preview/prev.png)]]
     11[[BR]]
     12[[br]]
     13([#point110.13 Top of Page])
     14
     15'''picons_black3d'''
     16
     17[[Image(source:/ipk/source/picons_black3d_SAT13_0/preview/prev.png)]]
     18[[Image(source:/ipk/source/picons_black3d_SAT19_2/preview/prev.png)]]
     19[[Image(source:/ipk/source/picons_black3d_SAT23_5/preview/prev.png)]]
     20[[BR]]
     21[[br]]
     22([#point10.13 Top of Page])
     23
     24'''picons_gold'''
     25
     26[[Image(source:/ipk/source/picons_gold_SAT13_0/preview/prev.png)]]
     27[[Image(source:/ipk/source/picons_gold_SAT19_2/preview/prev.png)]]
     28[[Image(source:/ipk/source/picons_gold_SAT23_5/preview/prev.png)]]
     29[[Image(source:/ipk/source/picons_gold_SAT28_2/preview/prev.png)]]
     30[[BR]]
     31[[br]]
     32([#point10.13 Top of Page])
     33
     34'''picons_Kabel'''
     35
     36[[Image(source:/ipk/source/picons_KabelBW/preview/prev.png)]]
     37[[Image(source:/ipk/source/picons_KabelDblack3d/preview/prev.png)]]
     38[[Image(source:/ipk/source/picons_KabelDtransparent/preview/prev.png)]]
     39[[Image(source:/ipk/source/picons_spiegel_SAT19_2/preview/prev.png)]]
     40[[BR]]
     41[[br]]
     42([#point10.13 Top of Page])
     43
     44'''picons_transparent_small_black'''
     45
     46[[Image(source:/ipk/source/picons_transparent_small_black_SAT19_2/preview/prev.png)]]
     47[[BR]]
     48[[br]]
     49([#point10.13 Top of Page])
     50
     51'''picons_white3d'''
     52
     53[[Image(source:/ipk/source/picons_white3d_SAT13_0/preview/prev.png)]]
     54[[Image(source:/ipk/source/picons_white3d_SAT19_2/preview/prev.png)]]
     55[[Image(source:/ipk/source/picons_white3d_SAT23_5/preview/prev.png)]]
     56[[Image(source:/ipk/source/picons_white3d_SAT28_2/preview/prev.png)]]
     57[[BR]]
     58[[br]]
     59([#point110.13 Top of Page])
     60
     61'''picons_white70'''
     62
     63[[Image(source:/ipk/source/picons_white70_SAT13_0/preview/prev.png)]]
     64[[Image(source:/ipk/source/picons_white70_SAT19_2/preview/prev.png)]]
     65[[Image(source:/ipk/source/picons_white70_SAT23_5/preview/prev.png)]]
     66[[Image(source:/ipk/source/picons_white70_SAT28_2/preview/prev.png)]]
     67[[BR]]
     68[[br]]
     69([#point10.13 Top of Page])
     70
     71'''picons_X_LightTransparen'''
     72
     73[[Image(source:/ipk/source/picons_X_LightTransparent_SAT13_0/preview/prev.png)]]
     74[[Image(source:/ipk/source/picons_X_LightTransparent_SAT19_2/preview/prev.png)]]
     75[[Image(source:/ipk/source/picons_X_LightTransparent_SAT23_5/preview/prev.png)]]
     76[[Image(source:/ipk/source/picons_X_LightTransparent_SAT28_2/preview/prev.png)]]
     77[[BR]]
     78[[br]]
     79([#point110.13 Top of Page])
     80
     81'''picons_X_LightTransparent_SAT19_2_small'''
     82
     83[[Image(source:/ipk/source/picons_X_LightTransparent_SAT19_2_small/preview/prev.png)]]
     84[[BR]]
     85[[br]]
     86([#point10.13 Top of Page])
     87
  • wiki/pages/nl/Power-Off-Timer

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2>----
     3>'''3.8.4 Power Off Timer''' [=#point3.8.4] ([wiki:Interface-Operation#point3.8 Standby-Poweroff (return)]) ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4>
     5>Menu Picture place holder:
     6>
     7>[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Power-Off-Timer.jpg)]][[br]]
     8>
     9> here you change your shutdown settings such as fixed shutdown timer.
     10
     11[[br]]
     12
  • wiki/pages/nl/Quick-Start-Guide

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2
     3----
     4'''Quick Start Guide''' [=#point0] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     5New Gui section work in progress expect dead links or missing data.
     6----
     7
     8TitanNit was designed to do two things really well. It can display live tv and it play your videos and recordings, the scope of this quick start guide will explain the setup and operation of those features in a short precise way.
     9This section was designed for those who do not care to ever read the manual and just want to jump in and get their hands dirty in all that is TitanNit.
     10
     11Note: It is asumed the decoder has just been freshly removed from the packing or freshly had TitanNit installed and is booted with the default settings if you wish to install TitanNit please see the section [wiki:Installation-Recovery#point8 Installation and Recovery Contents]
     12be aware that as TitanNit has been developed for multiple hardware devices the precedures outlined below may not be the same as your reciever.
     13
     14You may select a skip to a specific setup topic or scroll down to read the complete guide.
     15----
     16{{{#!div style="width: 1100px; margin: auto"
     17 {{{#!table style="border: none"
     18  {{{#!td align=center valign=top style="border: none; font-size: 115%"
     19  {{{#!div style="float: left"
     20[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/Common/Icons/quick-start-guide/Setting_Up_the_Language.png,align=left,link=[#point0.1])]]
     21  }}}
     22  '''([#point0.1 Setting Up the language])'''[[br]]
     23  {{{#!div style="float: left
     24click here to find info on setting up the language
     25  }}}
     26  }}}
     27  {{{#!td align=center valign=top style="border: none; font-size: 115%"
     28  {{{#!div style="float: left"
     29[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/Common/Icons/quick-start-guide/Setting_up_the_Network.png,align=left,link=[#point0.2])]]
     30  }}}
     31  '''([#point0.2 Setting Up the Network])'''[[br]]
     32  {{{#!div style="float: left
     33click here to find info on setting up the Network
     34  }}}
     35  }}}
     36  {{{#!td align=center valign=top style="border: none; font-size: 115%"
     37  {{{#!div style="float: left"
     38[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/Common/Icons/quick-start-guide/Setting_up_the_HDD.png,align=left,link=[#point0.3])]]
     39  }}}
     40  '''([#point0.3 Setting Up the Hdd])'''[[br]]
     41  {{{#!div style="float: left
     42click here to find info on setting up the HDD
     43  }}}
     44  }}}
     45  |---
     46  {{{#!td align=center valign=top style="border: none; font-size: 115%"
     47  {{{#!div style="float: left"
     48[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/Common/Icons/quick-start-guide/Setting_up-the_Tuner.png,align=left,link=[#point0.4])]]
     49  }}}
     50  '''([#point0.4 Setting Up the Tuner])'''[[br]]
     51  {{{#!div style="float: left
     52click here to find info on Setting Up the Tuner
     53  }}}
     54  }}}
     55  {{{#!td align=center valign=top style="border: none; font-size: 115%"
     56  {{{#!div style="float: left"
     57[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/Common/Icons/quick-start-guide/Preforming_a_Scan.png,align=left,link=[#point0.5])]]
     58  }}}
     59  '''([#point0.5 Proforming a Scan])'''[[br]]
     60  {{{#!div style="float: left
     61click here to find info Proforming a Scan
     62  }}}
     63  }}}
     64  {{{#!td align=center valign=top style="border: none; font-size: 115%"
     65  {{{#!div style="float: left"
     66[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/Common/Icons/quick-start-guide/Orginising_Your_Channels.png,align=left,link=[#point0.6])]]
     67  }}}
     68  '''([#point0.6 Orginising Your Channels])'''[[br]]
     69  {{{#!div style="float: left
     70click here to find info on Orginising Your Channels
     71  }}}
     72  }}}
     73  |---
     74  {{{#!td align=center valign=top style="border: none; font-size: 115%"
     75  {{{#!div style="float: left"
     76[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/Common/Icons/quick-start-guide/Setting_up_Media.png,align=left,link=[#point0.7])]]
     77  }}}
     78  '''([#point0.7 Setting Up a Media])'''[[br]]
     79  {{{#!div style="float: left
     80click here to find info on Setting Up a Media
     81  }}}
     82  }}}
     83  {{{#!td align=center valign=top style="border: none; font-size: 115%"
     84  {{{#!div style="float: left"
     85[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/Common/Icons/quick-start-guide/Playing_Back_Media.png,align=left,link=[#point0.8])]]
     86  }}}
     87  '''([#point0.8 Playing Back Media])'''[[br]]
     88  {{{#!div style="float: left
     89click here to find info Playing Back Media
     90  }}}
     91  }}}
     92  {{{#!td align=center valign=top style="border: none; font-size: 115%"
     93  {{{#!div style="float: left"
     94[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/Common/Icons/quick-start-guide/Conclusion.png,align=left,link=[#point0.9])]]
     95  }}}
     96  '''([#point0.9 Conclusion])'''[[br]]
     97  {{{#!div style="float: left
     98Conclusion/ what to do next after stting up Titan
     99  }}}
     100  }}}
     101  |----
     102  {{{#!td align=center valign=top style="border: none; font-size: 115%"
     103  {{{#!div style="float: left"
     104[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/Common/Icons/quick-start-guide/Apendixcies.png,align=left,link=[#point0.10])]]
     105  }}}
     106  '''([#point0.10 Apendixcies])'''[[br]]
     107  {{{#!div style="float: left
     108Apendixcies/ references [[br]]to other setup related topics.
     109  }}}
     110  }}}
     111}}}
     112}}}
     113[[br]]
     114[[br]]
     115
     116
     117
     118
     119
     120
     121
     122
     123----
     124''' Welcome to TitanNit! '''
     125----
     126 
     127Congratulations new users to your choice in your new Atemio Receiver or on the instalation of TitanNit onto your exising receiver. The TitanNit interface is designed with the 'Home Theater' in mind. This means it is best viewed on a large-screen TV while you sit on your couch 10-feet away from the TV, If it helps, you can think of TitanNit as the ultimate media player/Set-top-box, rather than just another set top box operating system.
     128 
     129
     130----
     131'''Setting Up the Language''' [=#point0.1] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     132----
     133By default the language of the TitanNit interface is in German and must be switched on setup to your language.
     134To set up the language of the interface go to menu the __"Menu"__ and select > __"Einstellungen"__ > __"Sprache"__ then select the language desired then the reciever will then reboot and restart with the new language settings.
     135
     136[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Language.jpg, 50%)]][[BR]]
     137[[br]]
     138[[br]]
     139
     140----
     141'''Setting Up the Network''' [=#point0.2] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     142----
     143To Set Up the Network Interface of the receiver go into the __"Menu"__ and select > __"System"__ > __"Network"__
     144
     145[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/system-Network.jpg, 50%)]][[BR]]
     146
     147If you wish to setup a wired network select __"LAN Interface Setup"__ and press the red button.
     148you will then be presented with a list of network settings, set up your reciever as required and press __"OK"__ and follow the on screen propmts.
     149
     150If you wish to setup a wireless network select __"WLAN"__
     151if your sever is sending out a ssid you may press the __"Red button"__ and preform a scan of available networks, select your network and press ok to save.
     152you will then need to set your security type and key using the remote and press the __"green button"__ to start the network connection.
     153[[br]]
     154[[br]]
     155
     156----
     157'''Setting Up the Hdd''' [=#point0.3] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     158----
     159If you have just purchased your receiver or converted from the manufactures included software the hdd will need formatting and setting up for use with TitanNit.
     160
     161To format the Hdd of the receiver to be able to be used with TitanNit go into the __"Menu"__ and select > __"System"__ > __"Storage Device"__ and select __"format Device"__ then select the hdd you wish to format. (Note: doing this will remove all content on the hdd if you have important data on there please back it up before preforming this step.)
     162
     163you will then need to select the type of file system you wish to use on the hdd if you have no idea what to pick leave it as default, select an item and press the __"OK"__ button.
     164
     165[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Format-Hdd.jpg, 50%)]][[br]]
     166
     167Now that the Hdd is formatted you may set it up, go into the __"Menu"__ and select > __"System"__ > __"Storage Device"__ and select __"Configure device"__
     168
     169Select the Hdd you formatted before and and then you will be presented with a set of features to enable the hard disk to be used for.
     170I suggest you enable all options.
     171[[br]]
     172[[br]]
     173
     174----
     175'''Setting up the Tuner''' [=#point0.4] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     176----
     177
     178Before you can watch TV you must set the tuner up in the Reciver as your system is physically connected to your Satellite cable or trestrial antenna.
     179
     180As no two systems are the same we will show you how to set up a simple single universal lnb connected to your reciever with a list of satellites in your sky you wish to receive.
     181
     182Before we can do this we need to program in a list of satellites and transponders as not all satellite lists are installed in the Reciever by default.
     183
     184''Setting up the default transponder/satellite lists''
     185
     186Programming in transponders can be quite daunting for new users so the devs have set up a simple way to program your transponders into yoru receiver, the [wiki:Create-Transponder-List#point3.5.1.7 Create Transponder List] function can download transponders for various services from the TitanNit online repo, this will save you from having to manually create these lists from your pc, receiver or from a satellite xml generator, this greatly simpifly channel and tuner setup.
     187(Note that these transponder lists may not allways be 100% correct as services may change)
     188
     189[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Create-Transponder-List.jpg, 50%)]][[br]]
     190 
     191Go into the __"Menu"__ and select > __"System"__ > __"Channel setup"__ > __"Create Transponder List"__ and follow the onscreen propmts to download a current list of transponders from your selected tuner type.
     192
     193
     194Alternativly you can use the[wiki:External-Software-SatChannelListEditor#point9.3 SatChannelListEditor] from your pc this is a little bit more flexible that you can just program in the satellites you wish to recieve as opposed to every satelite or transponder programmed into the repo, the hard core or pro users may prefer this option to customise their setup.
     195
     196Proform these steps in this sequence to import a list of satellites on to your receiver:
     197
     198 * Download a satellite xml file for the satellites you wish to receive from an [[http://satellites-xml.eu/ | Online xml generator]]
     199 * Download and install [wiki:External-Software-SatChannelListEditor#point9.3 SatChannelListEditor] to your pc and set up a connection to your receiver.
     200 * Import the xml file.
     201
     202[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/SCLE/Import-Satellite.png)]]
     203
     204
     205 * Upload the satellite.xml file to your receiver
     206
     207[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/SCLE/6.png)]]
     208
     209The reciever will then reboot if it does not then reboot manually to comit the changes.
     210
     211''Setting up the tuner''
     212
     213To Set up the Tuner of the receiver go into the __"Menu"__ and select > __"System"__ > __"Channel setup"__
     214
     215 * 1 Select tuner 0/0 and press the sideways key and select __"Tuner looped to 0/1"__
     216 * 2 Select tuner 0/1 and press the sideways key and select __"Tuner looped to 0/0"__
     217 * 3 Select tuner 0/0 and press the __"Red Button"__ to configuere the tuner
     218 * 4 Select the satellite type press sideways and select __"Single Lnb"__.
     219 * 5 Scroll down and select __"SAT 1"__ press the sideways key and select the satellite you wish to receive.
     220 * 6 Scroll down to Lnb/Unicable and press the __"Red Button"__ to configure the lnb type.
     221 * 7 scroll down to LOF/Unicable press the sideways key and select universal.
     222 * 8 Press ok button twice to store the lnb type and tuner configuration.
     223 * Repeat steps 4-8 on tuner 0/1
     224
     225your lnb is now set up and if all was done correctly you should now be able to scan for stations on the selected satellite.
     226[[br]]
     227[[br]]
     228
     229----
     230'''Proforming a Scan''' [=#point0.5] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     231----
     232
     233Before you can watch TV you must preform a scan of the transponders for available channels
     234
     235To Proforming a Scan of the receiver go into the __"Menu"__ and select > __"System"__ > __"Channel Service"__ >__"Automatic Search"__ and press the __"Red Button"__ as you have already setup your satellites and transponders the default settings will be ok.
     236
     237[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Automatic-Search.jpg, 50%)]]
     238
     239Once the scan has finished you may press the __"Green"__ button to store all the channel data or alternativly you may select the individual channels and press the __"Red"__ button.
     240
     241[[br]]
     242[[br]]
     243
     244----
     245'''Orginising Your Scanned Channels''' [=#point0.6] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     246----
     247Now you have your receiver setup you can start to watch tv if you exit from the menu after proforming the scan you should be presented with a high definition display of your local tv stations.
     248but as you may notice they are un orginised and it may be hard finding the tv stations you wish to watch for this you can orginise them in to your own persionalised favourite menu's.
     249The easyest way to do this is with the [wiki:External-Software-SatChannelListEditor#point9.3 SatChannelListEditor].
     250
     251 * Download and install [wiki:External-Software-SatChannelListEditor#point9.3 SatChannelListEditor] to your pc and set up a connection to your receiver.
     252 * Read in the channel data as follows :
     253
     254[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/SCLE/6.png)]]
     255
     256[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/SCLE/7.png)]]
     257
     258
     259'' Favourites setup ''
     260
     261All TV and Radio channels are displayed in the tab "TV" and "Radio" in the main window[[br]]
     262of SCLE. Normally there are several hundreds or thousands of channels in this list.
     263[[BR]] To simplify navigation on your Receiver you may add the channels to more than one Favourites list.[[br]]
     264The Favourites also determine the channel number for easier and direct access with your remote control.
     265[[BR]] Create new favourites by clicking the right mouse button within the tree of favourites:
     266
     267[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/SCLE/8.png)]]
     268
     269After creating the new Favourites entry assign the desired Name:
     270
     271[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/SCLE/9.png)]]
     272
     273You may now add channels to your favourites by drag & drop of the channels[[br]]
     274onto the Favourites entry or by clicking the right mouse button on the desired channel[[br]]
     275and selecting Add to Favourites and selecting the Favourites Entry from the drop-down-menu:
     276
     277[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/SCLE/10.png)]]
     278
     279Once a channel has been added to the favourites, a channel number is assigned.[[br]]
     280The first channel in the first favourites is channel number 1:
     281
     282[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/SCLE/11.png)]]
     283
     284When a channel is assigned to more than one favourites list, it additionally[[br]]
     285obtains further channel numbers:
     286
     287[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/SCLE/12.png)]]
     288[[br]]
     289[[br]]
     290
     291----
     292'''Setting Up a Media Source''' [=#point0.7] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     293----
     294To Set up a media source to be acessable from the reciever of the receiver go into the __"Menu"__ and select > __"System"__ > __"Network"__> __"Network Browser"__
     295
     296[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Network-Browser.jpg, 50%)]][[br]]
     297
     298now press the __"Red"__ button to add a source and you will be presented with a list of share options.
     299set up your share type adress and details for your media server and press __OK"__ to store it in.
     300
     301your share will now be mounted and it will now show up in the media/net/ directory
     302
     303[[br]]
     304[[br]]
     305
     306----
     307'''Playing Back Media''' [=#point0.8] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     308----
     309To Play back a media file or recording it is very simple, to open the default media player press the __"PLAY"__ button and you will be presented with the player file select display, Navigate the file list and select the file you wish to play.
     310You may play media from your network share by browsing to the media/net if you wish.
     311
     312[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Internal-Player-OSD.jpg, 50%)]][[br]]
     313[[br]]
     314[[br]]
     315
     316----
     317'''Conclusion''' [=#point0.9] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     318----
     319Conclusion
     320 
     321Thanks for reading this Quick Start Guide. Below in the "Apendixces" section you will find additional suggested reading that may be useful for getting started with the advanced features of TitanNit.
     322
     323[[br]]
     324[[br]]
     325
     326----
     327'''Apendixcies''' [=#point0.10] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     328----
     329Please see below for more advanced topics and information
     330
     331 * [wiki:Interface-Operation#point3 Interface and Operation]
     332 * [wiki:Remote-Device-Control#point3.9 Remote/ Device Control]
     333 * [wiki:Installation-Recovery#point8 Installation / Recovery]
     334 * [wiki:External-Software#point9 External Software]
     335 * [wiki:Plugins-Contents#point10 Plugins]
     336 * [wiki:Troubleshooting#point12 Troubleshooting]
     337
     338We have tried our best to make this quick start manual as complete and precice as we can if you have any issuies with this manual, wish for something to be added, thank or abuse us please see [wiki:Community#point14 Community] for information on how to contact us.
     339
     340Oh and by the way as a final remark thanks for choosing TitanNit!.
     341[[br]]
     342[[br]]
     343
  • wiki/pages/nl/Ram

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2>----
     3>'''3.7.8.6 Ram''' [=#point3.7.8.6] ([wiki:System-Info#point3.7.8 System Info (Back])
     4>
     5>
     6>[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/System-Info-Ram.jpg)]][[br]]
     7>
     8Here you can view the memory information.
     9
     10[[br]]
     11
     12
     13[[br]]
  • wiki/pages/nl/Receiver-Unlock

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2>----
     3>'''3.5.10 Receiver Unlock''' [=#point3.5.10] ([wiki:Interface-Operation#point3.5 System (Back)]) ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4>
     5>
     6>
     7>[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/system_receiver_unlock.jpg)]][[br]]
     8>
     9>Here you can unlock the special features of the decoder after purchase.
     10
     11[[br]]
  • wiki/pages/nl/Record-Path

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2>----
     3>'''3.6.8 Record Path''' [=#point3.6.8] ([wiki:Interface-Operation#point3.6 Settings (Back)])([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4>
     5>Menu Picture place holder:
     6>
     7>[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Record_Path.jpg)]][[BR]]
     8>
     9> here you can recording directorys.
     10
     11[[br]]
     12
     13 ||'''Movie  Path''' ||This is the path to the Movie Directory.||
     14 ||'''Timer Record Path:''' ||This is the path to the directory where the timer recordings are stored.||
     15 ||'''Record Patht''' ||This is the path to the directory where the manual recordings are stored.||
     16 ||'''Timeshift Path:''' ||This is the path to the directory where the Timeshift files are stored.||
     17 ||'''Stream Path''' ||This is the path to the directory where temporary Streams are stored.||
     18 
     19 To __"Store"__ the settings Exit from the EPG Settings Menu by pressing __"OK"__ or press __"Exit"__ to cancel changes.
     20 
     21[[br]]
     22----
     23
     24 '''Coloured Button's Functions"
     25
     26 The __"Coloured Buttons"__ along the bottom of the display bring up additional menus and options with in the epg settings menu.
     27 please see below for more info on the functions of these buttons:.
     28 
     29 ||'''Red Button: (Edit)''' ||This button allows editing of the above paths it will bring up an onscreen keyboard to edit the string selected.||
     30 
  • wiki/pages/nl/Records

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2>----
     3>'''3.1.5 Records''' [=#point3.1.5] ([wiki:Interface-Operation#point3.1 Records and EPG(Back)]) ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4>
     5>Menu Picture place holder:
     6>
     7>[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Records.jpg)]][[BR]]
     8>
     9>Recordings is where you can set up and edit timer set recordings.
     10
     11
     12[[br]]
     13
     14----
     15
     16 '''Coloured Button's Functions"
     17
     18 The __"Coloured Buttons"__ along the bottom of the display bring up additional menus and options with in the epg settings menu.
     19 please see below for more info on the functions of these buttons:.
     20 
     21 ||'''Red Button: (Del)''' ||This will delete the currently selected timer or recording.||
     22 ||'''Green Button: (Add)''' ||this will add a new timer recording.||
     23 ||'''Yellow Button: (Stop/ Start)''' ||this will stop or start the currently selected timer recording.||
     24 ||'''Blue Button: (log)''' ||This will show you the past log file for the past timer recordings.||
     25
  • wiki/pages/nl/Red-Button

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2>----
     3>'''3.6.4 Red Button''' [=#point3.6.4] ([wiki:Interface-Operation#point3.6 Settings (Back)])([wiki:Wiki#point0.2 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4
     5>
     6>Menu Picture place holder:
     7>
     8>[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Red_Button.jpg)]][[BR]]
     9>
     10>here you can configure what happens with the press of the red button
     11
     12
     13[[br]]
  • wiki/pages/nl/Remote-Device-Control

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2----
     3'''4 Remote/ Device control''' [=#point4] ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4New Gui section work in progress expect dead links or missing data.
     5----
     6== Remote/ Device control ==
     7
     8This section contains information about how to control your decoder and how it can be controlled from local and remote sources and helpfull information and tricks to get the most possible experience with your Receiver.
     9
     10
     11 ''Please select a menu item from the GUI for more information''
     12
     13----
     14{{{#!div style="width: 1100px; margin: auto"
     15 {{{#!table style="border: none"
     16  {{{#!td align=center valign=top style="border: none; font-size: 115%"
     17  {{{#!div style="float: left"
     18[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/Common/Icons/Remote-Device-Control/Remote_Control.png,align=left,link=[#point4.1])]]
     19  }}}
     20  '''[wiki:Remote-Device-Control#point4.1 4.1 RC Remote control]'''[[br]]
     21  {{{#!div style="float: left
     22click here to find info on setting up the language
     23  }}}
     24  }}}
     25  {{{#!td align=center valign=top style="border: none; font-size: 115%"
     26  {{{#!div style="float: left"
     27[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/Common/Icons/Remote-Device-Control/On_Device_control.png,align=left,link=[#point4.2])]]
     28  }}}
     29  '''[wiki:Remote-Device-Control#point4.2 4.2 On Device Control]'''[[br]]
     30  {{{#!div style="float: left
     31click here to find info on setting up the Network
     32  }}}
     33  }}}
     34  {{{#!td align=center valign=top style="border: none; font-size: 115%"
     35  {{{#!div style="float: left"
     36[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/Common/Icons/Remote-Device-Control/Web_Interface.png,align=left,link=[#point4.3])]]
     37  }}}
     38  '''[wiki:Remote-Device-Control#point4.3 4.3 Web Interface]'''[[br]]
     39  {{{#!div style="float: left
     40click here to find info on setting up the HDD
     41  }}}
     42  }}}
     43  |---
     44  {{{#!td align=center valign=top style="border: none; font-size: 115%"
     45  {{{#!div style="float: left"
     46[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/Common/Icons/Remote-Device-Control/Telnet_Control.png,align=left,link=[#point4.4])]]
     47  }}}
     48  '''[wiki:Remote-Device-Control#point4.4 4.4 Telnet Control]'''[[br]]
     49  {{{#!div style="float: left
     50click here to find info on Setting Up the Tuner
     51  }}}
     52  }}}
     53  {{{#!td align=center valign=top style="border: none; font-size: 115%"
     54  {{{#!div style="float: left"
     55[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/Common/Icons/Remote-Device-Control/Rgui.png,align=left,link=[#point4.5])]]
     56  }}}
     57  '''[wiki:Remote-Device-Control#point4.5 4.5 Rgui]'''[[br]]
     58  {{{#!div style="float: left
     59click here to find info Proforming a Scan
     60  }}}
     61  }}}
     62  {{{#!td align=center valign=top style="border: none; font-size: 115%"
     63  {{{#!div style="float: left"
     64[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/Common/Icons/Remote-Device-Control/Bootloader.png,align=left,link=[#point4.6])]]
     65  }}}
     66  '''[wiki:Remote-Device-Control#point4.6 4.6 Bootloader]'''[[br]]
     67  {{{#!div style="float: left
     68click here to find info on Orginising Your Channels
     69  }}}
     70  }}}
     71  |---
     72  {{{#!td align=center valign=top style="border: none; font-size: 115%"
     73  {{{#!div style="float: left"
     74[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/Common/Icons/Remote-Device-Control/TitanNit_WebIF.png,align=left,link=[#point4.7])]]
     75  }}}
     76  '''[wiki:Remote-Device-Control#point4.7 4.7 TitanNit WebIF]'''[[br]]
     77  {{{#!div style="float: left
     78click here to find info on Setting Up a Media
     79  }}}
     80  }}}
     81  {{{#!td align=center valign=top style="border: none; font-size: 115%"
     82  {{{#!div style="float: left"
     83[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/Common/Icons/Remote-Device-Control/FTP.png,align=left,link=[#point4.8])]]
     84  }}}
     85  '''[wiki:Remote-Device-Control#point4.8 4.8 FTP (File Transfer Protocol)]'''[[br]]
     86  {{{#!div style="float: left
     87click here to find info Playing Back Media
     88  }}}
     89  }}}
     90  {{{#!td align=center valign=top style="border: none; font-size: 115%"
     91  {{{#!div style="float: left"
     92[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/Common/Icons/Remote-Device-Control/Autostart_Scripting.png,align=left,link=[#point4.9])]]
     93  }}}
     94  '''[wiki:Remote-Device-Control#point4.9 4.9 Autostart Scripting (usercmd.sh)]'''[[br]]
     95  {{{#!div style="float: left
     96Conclusion/ what to do next after stting up Titan
     97  }}}
     98  }}}
     99 
     100}}}
     101}}}
     102[[br]]
     103[[br]]
     104
     105
     106
     107----
     108'''4.1 RC Remote Control''' [=#point4.1] ([#point4 top of the page])
     109
     110----
     111 * ([#point4.1.1 RC Atevio700])
     112 * ([#point4.1.2 RC Atevio7000, Atevio7500, Atemio7600])
     113 * ([#point4.1.3 RC Atemio500, Atemio510])
     114 * ([#point4.1.4 RC Atemio520])
     115 * ([#point4.1.5 RC Atemio520-V2])
     116 * ([#point4.1.6 RC Atemio530])
     117
     118 * ([#point4.1.7 RC UFS910])
     119 * ([#point4.1.8 RC UFS912])
     120 * ([#point4.1.9 RC UFS922])
     121
     122[[BR]]
     123[[BR]]
     124[[BR]]
     125
     126
     127
     128
     129'''4.1.1 RC Remote Control Atevio700''' [=#point4.1.1]  ([#point4.1 back])
     130[[BR]]
     131{{{#!th rowspan=0 align=left style="border: none"
     132[[Image(source:/titan/web/img/rc.atevio700.png)]][[br]]
     133}}}
     134|----------------
     135{{{#!td style="border: none"
     136 
     137'''TEXT RC Atevio 700'''
     138
     139}}}
     140
     141[[br]]
     142[[br]]
     143[[br]]
     144
     145
     146
     147'''4.1.2 RC Remote Control Atevio7000, Atevio7500, Atemio7600''' [=#point4.1.2]  ([#point4.1 back])
     148[[BR]]
     149{{{#!th rowspan=0 align=left style="border: none"
     150[[Image(source:/titan/web/img/rc.atevio7000.png)]][[br]]
     151}}}
     152|----------------
     153{{{#!td style="border: none"
     154 The section contains information on the functions and operation of your remote control unit.
     155
     156 '''Special Function Buttons operation during channel streaming'''
     157
     158 
     159 ||'''Resolution:''' ||This Key Switches the videomode.||
     160 ||'''V.Format:''' ||This Key Switches the Video format.||
     161 ||'''Recall:''' ||This key can bring up the recent channel history so you can jump easily between programs.||
     162 ||'''Info:''' ||This Button displays the infobar.||
     163 ||'''fav:''' ||This button brings up the favourite and Bouquet lists to easily select programs.||
     164 ||'''Menu:''' ||This key opens the menu.||
     165 ||'''Sleep:''' ||This Key can setup the sleep timer.||
     166 ||'''Help:''' ||This key can display detailed information and help text's.||
     167 ||'''Exit:''' ||This key exits menus and popups .||
     168 ||'''text:''' ||This key shows the teletext display.||
     169 ||'''Ok:''' ||This button confirms menu items and popups.||
     170
     171[[br]]
     172
     173'''Programming the universal remote to operate a supported TV'''
     174
     175This section explains how to automatically search and program your universal remote control to operate your tv
     176
     177NOTE: If there are no inputs for 10 seconds during setting the TV RC code the setting mode is terminated.
     178
     179'''Automatic code search '''
     180
     181 * Press the TV / Atevio button on the remote (for at least 3 seconds) until the LED flashes twice.
     182
     183   Enter the code 001. The LED flashes twice to confirm the entry.
     184
     185 * Press and hold the "ON / OFF" button until the TV turns off.
     186   
     187   Note: The LED flashes every 1.5 seconds and sends a new TV power rc code.
     188
     189 * Release the button immediately then press the "OK" button to store the TV code.
     190
     191  (This can take up to 15 minutes to cycle all the tv's pre programmed in to the remote from the factory)
     192
     193   If you dont let go of the power key in time it will step to the next RC Power button code if this happens use the D-Pad down to rewind 5 codes to attempt to store the code again.
     194
     195 * To interrupt the search mode, press the Exit button for 2 seconds and return to normal operation or wait for 10 seconds with no key presses.
     196
     197 * The remote control blinks 5 times at the end of the list if the tv has not turned off by the time your tv is not a supported model.
     198
     199'''Reset remote to factory programming'''
     200
     201This will reset the remote back to a factory non programmed state, this is necessary if the remote  needs to be reprogrammed to operate a new TV and was previously programmed.
     202
     203 * Press the TV / Atevio button on the remote (for at least 3 seconds) until the LED flashes twice.
     204
     205 * Enter the code 000.
     206 
     207 * The LED flashes twice to confirm the entry. The remote control will now be reset (no code programmed)
     208
     209
     210}}}
     211
     212[[br]]
     213[[br]]
     214[[br]]
     215
     216'''4.1.3 RC Remote Control Atemio 500 / Atemio 510''' [=#point4.1.3]  ([#point4.1 back])
     217[[BR]]
     218{{{#!th rowspan=0 align=left style="border: none"
     219[[Image(source:/titan/web/img/rc.atemio510.png)]][[br]]
     220}}}
     221|----------------
     222{{{#!td style="border: none"
     223 
     224'''TEXT RC Atemio 500/510'''
     225
     226}}}
     227
     228[[br]]
     229[[br]]
     230[[br]]
     231
     232'''4.1.4 RC Remote Control Atemio 520''' [=#point4.1.4]  ([#point4.1 back])
     233[[BR]]
     234{{{#!th rowspan=0 align=left style="border: none"
     235[[Image(source:/titan/web/img/rc.atemio520.png)]][[br]]
     236}}}
     237|----------------
     238{{{#!td style="border: none"
     239 
     240'''TEXT RC Atemio 520'''
     241
     242}}}
     243
     244[[br]]
     245[[br]]
     246[[br]]
     247
     248'''4.1.5 RC Remote Control Atemio 520 V2''' [=#point4.1.5]  ([#point4.1 back])
     249[[BR]]
     250{{{#!th rowspan=0 align=left style="border: none"
     251[[Image(source:/titan/web/img/rc.atemio520-V2.png)]][[br]]
     252}}}
     253|----------------
     254{{{#!td style="border: none"
     255 
     256'''TEXT RC Atemio 520-V2'''
     257
     258}}}
     259
     260[[br]]
     261[[br]]
     262[[br]]
     263
     264'''4.1.6 RC Remote Control Atemio 530''' [=#point4.1.6]  ([#point4.1 back])
     265[[BR]]
     266{{{#!th rowspan=0 align=left style="border: none"
     267[[Image(source:/titan/web/img/rc.atemio530.png)]][[br]]
     268}}}
     269|----------------
     270{{{#!td style="border: none"
     271 
     272'''TEXT RC Atemio 530'''
     273
     274}}}
     275
     276[[br]]
     277[[br]]
     278[[br]]
     279
     280
     281'''4.1.7 RC Remote Control Kathrein UFS910''' [=#point4.1.7]  ([#point4.1 back])
     282[[BR]]
     283{{{#!th rowspan=0 align=left style="border: none"
     284[[Image(source:/titan/web/img/rc.ufs910.png)]][[br]]
     285}}}
     286|----------------
     287{{{#!td style="border: none"
     288 
     289'''TEXT RC UFS 910'''
     290
     291}}}
     292
     293[[br]]
     294[[br]]
     295[[br]]
     296
     297
     298
     299
     300'''4.1.8 RC Remote Control Kathrein UFS912''' [=#point4.1.8]  ([#point4.1 back])
     301[[BR]]
     302{{{#!th rowspan=0 align=left style="border: none"
     303[[Image(source:/titan/web/img/rc.ufs912.png)]][[br]]
     304}}}
     305|----------------
     306{{{#!td style="border: none"
     307 
     308'''TEXT RC UFS912'''
     309
     310}}}
     311
     312[[br]]
     313[[br]]
     314[[br]]
     315
     316
     317
     318'''4.1.9 RC Remote Control Kathrein UFS922''' [=#point4.1.9]  ([#point4.1 back])
     319[[BR]]
     320{{{#!th rowspan=0 align=left style="border: none"
     321[[Image(source:/titan/web/img/rc.ufs922.png)]][[br]]
     322}}}
     323|----------------
     324{{{#!td style="border: none"
     325 
     326'''TEXT RC UFS922'''
     327
     328}}}
     329
     330[[br]]
     331[[br]]
     332[[br]]
     333
     334
     335
     336[[br]]
     337----
     338'''4.2 On Device Control''' [=#point4.2] ([#point4 top of the page])
     339
     340----
     341
     342
     343[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/On_Device_Control.jpg)]][[br]]
     344
     345The section contains information on the functions and operation of your Receiver from the onboard buttons.
     346Please note: the control is very limited from the on device controls but simple menu and tv control's can be made:
     347
     348'''Device Controll keys'''
     349
     350 
     351 ||'''Power''' ||This Key Switches to the power menu or shuts down depending on the "power action" see ([#point3.6.6 Adjust]) for more info. ||
     352 ||'''Menu:''' ||This Key brongs up the on screen display/ menu. ||
     353 ||'''Ok:''' ||This key accept on screen prompts. ||
     354 ||'''D-pad:''' ||These buttons can control the volume and TV channel when on the TV display it can also be used to navigate the menu and on screen prompts. ||
     355
     356----
     357'''4.3 Web Interface''' [=#point4.3] ([#point4 top of the page])
     358----
     359
     360[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Web_Control.jpg)]][[br]]
     361
     362The section contains information on the functions and operation of your Receiver from the web interface over LWAN, LAN or wifi.
     363
     364[[br]]
     365
     366----
     367'''4.3.1 Channel list''' [=#point4.3.1] ([#point4 top of the page])
     368----
     369
     370[[br]]
     371
     372 ||'''All''' ||Show All Channels from all Bouquets .||
     373 ||'''Sat''' ||Sort channels By Satellite.||
     374 ||'''provider:''' ||Sort channels By provider.||
     375 ||'''A-Z:''' ||Sort channels Alphabetically.||
     376 ||'''Bouquets:''' ||Sort channels By Boquet.||
     377
     378
     379[[br]]
     380----
     381'''4.3.2 Box Control''' [=#point4.3.2] ([#point4 top of the page])
     382----
     383
     384[[br]]
     385 
     386 ||'''Power Control:''' ||This brings up the links to control the power settings (shutdown, restart, etc....)||
     387 ||'''Message:''' ||Send a message to the display of the tv.||
     388 ||'''Remote:''' ||Bring up the remote on the web page for control of the decoder.||
     389 ||'''Screenshot OSD:''' ||Take a screen shot of the OSD.||
     390 ||'''Play Movie (URL:''' ||Play a movie from the selected url.||
     391
     392[[br]]
     393----
     394'''4.3.3 Movies''' [=#point4.3.3] ([#point4 top of the page])
     395----
     396
     397[[br]]
     398
     399This will bring up a list of the movie directory on the receiver please see ([#point3.12.5 Web Controls]) for more information
     400
     401[[br]]
     402----
     403'''4.3.4 Timer''' [=#point4.3.4] ([#point4 top of the page])
     404----
     405
     406[[br]]
     407 
     408 ||'''Timer List:''' ||Show a list of the timer Recordings.||
     409 ||'''Timer Archive:''' ||Show a list of all the completed timer recordings.||
     410 ||'''Add Timer:''' ||Add a timer recording.||
     411
     412[[br]]
     413----
     414'''4.3.5 System''' [=#point4.3.5] ([#point4 top of the page])
     415----
     416
     417[[br]]
     418 
     419 ||'''Extensions:''' ||Show a list of alailable extensions and plugins to install.||
     420 ||'''System update:''' ||Update the system  software.||
     421 ||'''System Backup:''' ||backup the system to an image file.||
     422 ||'''Settings Backup/ restore:''' ||Take/ restore a backup of the current settings and config.||
     423
     424[[br]]
     425----
     426'''4.3.6 Settings''' [=#point4.3.6] ([#point4 top of the page])
     427----
     428
     429[[br]]
     430
     431 ||'''system settings:''' ||This brings up a list of the items in the adjust menu of the receiver See [wiki:Adjust#point3.6.6 Adjust] for more information on the items in this menu.||
     432 ||'''Oscam web interface:''' ||Shows config http information for the oscam plugin (if installed).||
     433 ||'''Xupnpd:''' ||Shows information on the Xupnpd media streaming plugin.||
     434
     435[[br]]
     436----
     437'''4.3.7 Information''' [=#point4.3.7] ([#point4 top of the page])
     438----
     439[[br]]
     440
     441This section contains detailed config and system info about your reciever and TitanNit.
     442Please see the below links for more information on the items contained with in this menu.
     443
     444 * ([wiki:Service#point3.7.1 Service])
     445 * ([wiki:News-letter#point3.7.2 News letter])
     446 * ([wiki:About#point3.7.3 About])
     447 * ([wiki:Streaming#point3.7.4 Streaming])
     448 * ([wiki:Atemio-Hotline#point3.7.5 Atemio (Hotline)])
     449 * ([wiki:Titan-Changelog#point3.7.6 Titan Changelog])
     450 * ([wiki:Git-Changelog#point3.7.7 Git Changelog])
     451 * ([wiki:System-Info#point3.7.8 System Info])
     452 * ([wiki:Log#point3.7.9 Log])
     453
     454[[br]]
     455----
     456'''4.3.8 Help''' [=#point4.3.8] ([#point4 top of the page])
     457----
     458
     459[[br]]
     460 
     461 ||'''Offline help:''' ||Currently this has no function and is for future use.||
     462 ||'''Online help:''' ||Shows this wiki from the web interface for help and support.||
     463
     464
     465[[br]]
     466----
     467'''4.3.9 Web Controls''' [=#point4.3.9] ([#point4 top of the page])
     468----
     469
     470[[br]]
     471
     472'''Filelist Display Web Buttons'''
     473
     474This section explains the functions and discriptions of the icons displayed on the web page along side the file list display.
     475
     476 ||[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Web_Webstream.png)]] ||This button plays the selected program (web Stream) ||
     477 ||[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Web_Stream.png)]] ||This button plays the selected program (Stream) ||
     478 ||[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Web_Delete.png)]] ||This button deletes the selected program ||
     479 ||[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Web_Edit.png)]] ||This button downloads the selected program ||
     480 ||[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Web_Singleepg.png)]] ||This button displays the (EPG) ||
     481 ||[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/web_radio.png)]] ||This button shows the selected channel is audio only (radio)||
     482 ||[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/web_tv.png)]] ||This button shows the selected channel is audio and video (TV)||
     483 ||[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Web_Cross.png)]] ||This button shows the selected channel is not available ||
     484 
     485
     486'''Other Web Buttons'''
     487
     488This section explains the functions and discriptions icons displayed on the web page title area.
     489
     490 ||[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Web_Rcopen.png)]] ||This button shows or hides the onscreen remote control ||
     491 ||[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Web_Poweroff.png)]] ||This button turns off the Receiver ||
     492 ||[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Web_Restart.png)]] ||This button restarts the Receiver ||
     493 ||[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Web_Guirestart.png)]] ||This button restarts the GUI ||
     494 ||[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Web_Standby.png)]] ||This button puts the receiver into standby ||
     495 ||[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Web_Speak_On.png)]] ||This button mute's the sound ||
     496 ||[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/web_led_on.png)]] ||These buttons select the volume 10 to 100% (left to right) ||
     497 ||[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Web_Record.png)]] ||This button starts a Recording ||
     498 ||[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Web_Signal.png)]] ||This button shows the signal info's ||
     499 ||EPG Search ||This box enables you to search the EPG type your test into the box and press enter. ||
     500
     501[[br]]
     502----
     503
     504To open the web interface, use an Internet browser and enter the ip address of your decoder in the adress bar as follows: you may find your ip adress from the system information/network display.
     505
     506http:// IP.of.receiver
     507
     508[[br]]
     509
     510
     511----
     512'''4.4 Telnet Control''' [=#point4.4] ([#point4 top of the page])
     513----
     514
     515
     516[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Telnet_Control.jpg)]][[br]]
     517
     518The section contains information on the operation of your Receiver over a telnet session.
     519
     520'''Telnet Setup'''
     521
     522 * Eithernet Interface Telnet Setup
     523
     524  1 A Network connection must be active
     525
     526  2 Install the client found here: ([http://www.chiark.greenend.org.uk/~sgtatham/putty/download.html Putty]).
     527
     528  3 Find the IP address from the system info ([wiki:Network#point3.7.8.5 Network]) section
     529
     530  4 Insert the IP address info into the telnet client
     531
     532  5 Click connect.
     533
     534[[br]]
     535 
     536 * Serial Interface Telnet Setup
     537
     538  1 Connect a null modem cable between the Receiver and PC
     539
     540  2 Install the client found here: ([http://www.chiark.greenend.org.uk/~sgtatham/putty/download.html Putty])
     541
     542  3 Set up the serial port connection parameters
     543
     544  4 Click connect.
     545
     546After the above steps are completed you will now be presented with a console where you can login to your Receiver with a username and password.
     547
     548after entering your login information there are a few receiver specific functions that may be handy if you require information on basic telnet commands i suggest you have a look on [http://www.linux.org linux.org]
     549
     550'''Remote RC debugging'''
     551{{{
     552#!python
     553killall -9 evremote2
     554evremote2
     555}}}
     556[[br]]
     557
     558'''Start FTDI driver'''
     559{{{
     560#!python
     561mknod / dev.static/ttyUSB0 c 188 0"
     562}}}
     563[[br]]
     564
     565'''Test FTDI driver commands'''
     566{{{
     567#!python
     568ls-al / dev/ttyUSB0
     569}}}
     570[[br]]
     571
     572{{{
     573#!python
     574cat /proc/bus/usb/devices
     575}}}
     576[[br]]
     577
     578{{{
     579#!python
     580lsmod | grep usbserial
     581}}}
     582[[br]]
     583
     584'''Take a screen shot'''
     585{{{
     586#!python
     587/sbin/grab -j 100 -r 960 /tmp/000.jpg
     588}}}
     589
     590----
     591'''4.5 Rgui''' [=#point4.5] ([#point4 top of the page])
     592----
     593[[br]]
     594
     595[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Mainmenu.jpg)]][[br]]
     596
     597
     598RGui is a TitanNit plugin which allows you to operate your Receiver from a different Receiver. Only the Gui is completely transmitted.
     599
     600Thus one can operate the receiver remotely, but not stream the TV signal.
     601
     602[[br]]
     603
     604
     605
     606 
     607
     608----
     609'''4.6 Bootloader''' [=#point4.6] ([#point4 top of the page])
     610----
     611[[br]]
     612
     613[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/On_Device_Control.jpg)]][[br]]
     614
     615
     616== Iboot is a boot loader. ==
     617
     618"written by Solala based on based on the project uboot by wolfgang denk [http://www.denx.de]"  (Iboot is included in versions of TitanNit from 1.32 for the atemio and atevio receivers) [[br]]
     619Please note that there is differences between the Iboot menu structure on the different models of decoders.
     620
     621''' Functions of the boot loader:'''
     622
     623* Identification of the Hardware
     624* Starting the Image
     625
     626
     627''' Iboot early startup menu '''
     628
     629To enter the Iboot startup menu shutdown the receiver and power up pressing the __"Menu"__ button on the remote control.
     630Iboot will then startup showing __"Flash Menu"__ on the VFDisplay from here you may scroll through the list of available menu items using the D-pad -OK- and -Exit- buttons on the RC Remote.
     631
     632
     633----
     634''' Expert Mode ''' (not present in av700/7000)
     635----
     636
     637[[br]]
     638
     639Expert mode is a setting allowing you to enable the advanced menu in Iboot that are hidden by default as these extra setting's enable such features as overclocking that could void your warranty.
     640
     641To switch Iboot into __"Expert Mode"__ Shutdown the receiver and power up pressing the __"Menu"__ button on the remote control .
     642Iboot will then startup showing __"Flash Menu"__ on the VFDisplay
     643
     644now using D-pad left / right select __"SETTINGS"__  and with up / down button select __"set OSD color"__ and click __"OK"__
     645now using the left and right D-pad buttons  left / right to change the colors
     646with up / down set the colors individually to
     647
     648for the '''AM 510/AM520 ''' the code is
     649
     650 * Red = 11
     651
     652 * Green = 47
     653
     654 * Blue = 11
     655
     656for the '''AM 7500/7600 ''' the code is
     657 
     658 * Red = 7
     659
     660 * Green = 10
     661
     662 * Blue = 5
     663
     664
     665Then press the __"Exit"__ button twice to return to the menu __"Flash"__ the display on the TV screen should now show:
     666
     667''' ! YOU ACTIVATED EXPERT MODE ! ''' - expert mode enabled
     668
     669''' ! NO WARRANTY ----- USE AT YOUR OWN RISK ! ''' No warranty - use at your own risk
     670
     671if you dont agree : execute ''' " Clean Environment Sector" ''' in the FLASH MENU
     672
     673if you do not want to lose the warranty, you must run ''' " Clean Environment Sector" ''' in the FLASH MENU
     674
     675[[br]]
     676
     677----
     678'''4.6.1 Main categories''''  [=#point4.6.1] [#point4.6 (back)]   
     679----
     680Please select an item below to see more information.
     681
     682[#point4.6.2 (Menu Flash)]
     683
     684[#point4.6.3 (Settings)]
     685
     686[#point4.6.4 (Menu Misc)]
     687
     688[#point4.6.5 (Menu Net)] (not present in av700/7000)
     689
     690
     691== Subcategories ==
     692
     693----
     694'''4.6.2 Menu Flash ''' [=#point4.6.2] [#point4.6 (back)]
     695
     696 ||'''USB IRDupdt Image''' ||flash (depending on SETTINGS > Select USB / SATA dev 1-4) via USB stick or USB HDD from sda1 (standard).||
     697 ||'''USBirds list''' ||If several ird Image's are on the USB stick, you can display them, select and then flash the desired one. ||
     698 ||'''Clean environment Sector''' ||Resets the bootargs and resets Iboot to the default settings this disables __"Expert Mode"__. ||
     699 ||'''Clean flash ! Include swap''' ||Deletes the entire image, including the swap area, so all settings, plugins, backups, etc.... are removed. ||
     700 ||'''SATA IRDupdt''' ||look for an ird image on the internal or an external SATA hdd / flash stick (not present in av700/7000). ||
     701 ||'''list SATAirds''' ||When multiple ird Images are stored on the internal or external SATA hdd / flash stick, you can display them select and then flash the desired one (not present in av700/7000). ||
     702 ||'''7 . Allow Iboot Update''' ||This is a developer option included in development bootloaders so you just can flash the ird image ignoring the included boot loader if you wish this setting is not present in av700/7000). ||
     703
     704[[br]]
     705
     706----
     707'''4.6.3 Menu Settings ''' [=#point4.6.3] [#point4.6 (back)]
     708
     709 ||'''Turbosw'''||Select overclocking speeds available settings are (0)265, (1)265, (2)297, (3)297, (4)333, (5)333, (6)364, (7)364. ||
     710 ||'''Timeout'''||Delay befor selecting the default boot option. ||
     711 ||'''USB Sleep'''||???. ||
     712 ||'''Scroll Speed'''||How fast the VFDisplay module moves. ||
     713
     714[[br]]
     715
     716----
     717'''4.6.4 Menu Misc''' [=#point4.6.4] [#point4.6 (back)]
     718
     719 ||'''Disclaimer''' ||Shows the info on the bootloader. ||
     720 ||'''Serial Console''' ||Enables Bootloader serial debugging. ||
     721 ||'''Reset Board'''||Resets the Receiver and restarts boot process. ||
     722
     723
     724
     725
     726
     727[[br]]
     728
     729----
     730''' Menu Net ''' [=#point4.6.5] [#point4.6 (back)]
     731
     732Please note menu item has been superceded and now has no function and it can be ignored. [[br]]
     733Due to image updates the network setting does not need to be passed on by the bootloader.
     734
     735[[br]]
     736
     737
     738----
     739'''4.7 TitanNit Web-IF (Htmlapi)''' [=#point4.7] ([#point4 top of the page])
     740----
     741
     742[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Web_Control.jpg)]][[br]]
     743
     744The section contains information on the operation and control of your decoder from the Htmlapi.
     745
     746[[br]]
     747
     748TitanNit provides its own Htmlapi that is freely distributed so that other developers may interface with a receiver running titan.
     749
     750
     751The Htmlapi is very simple to implement an example message structure is as follows:
     752
     753 * query?param&param&... for html output
     754
     755 * queryraw?param&param&... for raw-struct output
     756
     757
     758For example if you would wish to send a RC remote keypress of the "Mute" key the message format would be as follows:
     759
     760 * __query?sendrc&rcmute__
     761
     762
     763if you would like to retrieve a list of all the current satelites the format would be as follows:
     764
     765 * __queryraw?getsat__
     766
     767
     768the output message back from the Receiver would be as follows:
     769
     770 * __satname#orbitalpos__
     771and an example raw output would be:
     772
     773> {{{Optus_d2#160}}}[[br]]
     774> {{{Optus_d1#166}}}[[br]]
     775> {{{Intelsat_IS19#156}}}[[br]]
     776
     777''more information on the protocol and the query strings can be found here [http://sbnc.dyndns.tv/trac/browser/titan/doc/htmlapi.txt htmlapi.txt]''
     778
     779[[br]]
     780
     781----
     782'''4.8 FTP (File Transfer Protocol)''' [=#point4.8] ([#point4 top of the page])
     783----
     784
     785[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Filezilla.jpg)]][[br]]
     786
     787The section contains information on how to setup a FTP connection to your TitanNit Receiver.
     788
     789[[br]]
     790
     791Titan Has an inbuilt FTP Server that is able to be used to transfer files to and from your Receiver.
     792
     793To connect to your receiver you can connect via your browser in windows or use a dedicated FTP program as with many linux programs the default password and user name is "root" and port 21 is the default FTP interface port.
     794
     795You connect to your receiver via internet explorer on your pc to do this you need to find the IP address fo the decoder from the system information menu [wiki:System-info-Network#point3.7.8.4 Network Information] of your receiver and type it into the address bas as follows:
     796
     797{{{ftp://Username:Password@Ip_Address:Port_Number}}}
     798
     799{{{ftp://root:root@192.168.0.1:21}}}
     800
     801if you Wish to use a dedicated FTP program please read the documentation supplied with your program for information on setup of the FTP connection, Below is a screen shot of Filezilla a popular Free FTP client Program with a sample loggin details of my Receiver.
     802
     803[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/FileZilla-Setup.jpg)]][[br]]
     804
     805----
     806 '''4.9 autostart scripting (usercmd)''' [=#point4.9] ([#point4 top of the page])
     807----
     808
     809If you wish to run a script on startup of the Receiver you can install commands in the usercmd.sh to be proformed at the startup of the receiver.
     810
     811a sample of the usercmd.sh is below:
     812
     813{{{
     814#!python
     815#! / bin / sh
     816 # Start the user commands here
     817echo " [ usercmd.sh ] start"
     818 # insert code here
     819 exit
     820}}}
     821
     822the {{{__"# insert code here"__}}} section must be replaced by your commands.
     823
     824If you place the following code in to the usercmd.sh it will delete every time shift file on the internal hdd on startup of the receiver:
     825
     826{{{
     827#!python
     828rm -f /media/hdd/movie/timeshift*.ts
     829}}}
     830
     831If you place the following code in to the usergmd.sh it will autostart the FTDI driver.
     832{{{
     833#!python
     834mknod / dev.static/ttyUSB0 c 188 0"
     835}}}
     836[[br]]
     837
     838
     839the full path to the file is:
     840__"/mnt/config/usercmd.sh"__
     841
     842
     843
     844
     845
     846
  • wiki/pages/nl/Restore-Default-Settings

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2>----
     3>'''3.6.13 Restore Default Settings''' [=#point3.6.13] ([wiki:Interface-Operation#point3.6 Settings (Back)])([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4>
     5>Menu Picture place holder:
     6>
     7>[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Restore_Default_Settings.jpg)]][[BR]]
     8>
     9>here you can return your device to the default settings.
     10
     11[[br]]
     12
     13 ||'''Restore Default Settings:''' ||This will restore the settings to the factory default condition.||
     14 ||'''Format MNT With Backup / Restore:''' ||This will format the Mount partition after preforming a backup thern it will restore the restore the backup retaining your settings.||
     15 ||'''Format MNT (all):''' ||This will format the Mount partition deleting all settings to default condition.||
     16 
     17 
     18 To __"Store"__ the settings Exit from the EPG Settings Menu by pressing __"OK"__ or press __"Exit"__ to cancel changes.
     19 
     20[[br]]
     21----
  • wiki/pages/nl/Rotor-Settings

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2>----
     3>'''3.5.1.4 Rotor Settings''' [=#point3.5.1.4] ([wiki:Channel-Service#point3.5.1 Channel-Service (Back)]) ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4>
     5>
     6>[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Rotor-Settings.jpg)]][[br]]
     7>
     8Here you can adjust your rotor settings
     9
     10[[br]]
     11
     12 ||'''Move''' || Select move mode.||
     13 ||'''Fine Move:''' || Select fine move.||
     14 ||'''Limit:''' || Select satellite motor limits.||
     15 ||'''Go to start pos:''' || Goto the satellite starting position.||
     16 ||'''storage position:''' || Select storage position.||
     17   
     18 To __"Store"__ the settings Exit from the EPG Settings Menu by pressing __"OK"__ or press __"Exit"__ to cancel changes.
     19
     20 '''Coloured Button's Functions'''
     21
     22 The __"Coloured Buttons"__ along the bottom of the display bring up additional menus and options with in rotor settings.
     23  Please see below for more info on the functions of these buttons these functions depend on the selected menu item as follows:.
     24
     25'''During Move'''
     26 
     27 ||'''Red Button: (Move West)''' ||Set the sort method for the files listed in the file list display.||
     28 ||'''Green Button: (Search west)''' ||Play the selected media file.||
     29 ||'''Yellow button: (search east)''' ||Show the EPG information on the current selected media file (If present)||
     30 ||'''Blue button: (move east)''' ||Set the sort method for the files listed in the file list display.||
     31
     32'''During Fine Move'''
     33
     34 ||'''Green Button: (Step west)''' ||Play the selected media file.||
     35 ||'''Yellow Button: (Step East)''' ||Show the EPG information on the current selected media file (If present)||
     36
     37'''During Limit'''
     38 
     39 ||'''Red Button: (limit Off)''' ||Set the sort method for the files listed in the file list display.||
     40 ||'''Green Button: (limit West)''' ||Play the selected media file.||
     41 ||'''Yellow button: (limit East)''' ||Show the EPG information on the current selected media file (If present)||
     42 ||'''Blue button: (limit On)''' ||Set the sort method for the files listed in the file list display.||
     43 
     44
     45'''During goto start position'''
     46 
     47 ||'''Red Button: (Start Position)''' ||go to the selected start position.||
     48
     49
     50'''During Storage Position'''
     51 
     52 ||'''Green Button: (Storage Position)''' ||store selected storage position.||
     53 ||'''Yellow Button: (Goto Position)''' ||move dish to the stored position||
  • wiki/pages/nl/Sat-Finder

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2>----
     3>'''3.5.1.5 Sat Finder''' [=#point3.5.1.5] ([wiki:Channel-Service#point3.5.1 Channel-Service (Back)]) ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4>
     5>
     6>[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Sat-Finder.jpg)]][[br]]
     7>
     8Here you can check your signal info for the current selected channel.
     9
     10[[br]]
     11
  • wiki/pages/nl/Screensaver-Adjust

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2>----
     3>'''3.6.8 Screensaver Adjust''' [=#point3.6.8] ([wiki:Interface-Operation#point3.6 Settings (Back)])([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4>
     5>
     6>[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Screensaver_Adjust.jpg)]][[BR]]
     7>
     8>Here you can setup your screen saver
     9
     10[[br]]
     11
     12
     13
     14 ||'''Screensaver''' ||enable or disable the screensaver display||
     15 ||'''Screensaver Delay:''' ||Set the delat time before the screen saver is displayed.||
     16 ||'''Screensaver Interval:''' ||Set the display time of the Screensaver in multi Pic Mode.||
     17 ||'''Screensaver Type:''' ||Select the type of Screensaver to display on the screen.||
     18 ||'''Screensaver Background:''' ||Select the background during display of the Screensaver.||
     19 ||'''Screensaver Pic:''' ||IN Image mode select the picture to Display as the Screensaver.||
     20 
     21 To __"Store"__ the settings Exit from the EPG Settings Menu by pressing __"OK"__ or press __"Exit"__ to cancel changes.
     22 
     23[[br]]
     24----
  • wiki/pages/nl/Service

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2>----
     3>'''3.7.1 Service''' [=#point3.7.1] ([wiki:Interface-Operation#point3.7 Information (Back)])([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4>
     5>Menu Picture place holder:
     6>
     7>[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Service.jpg)]][[BR]]
     8>
     9> here you view information on the currently selected service.
     10
     11[[br]]
     12
     13'''Coloured Button's Functions"
     14
     15 The __"Coloured Buttons"__ along the bottom of the display bring up additional menus and options with in the epg settings menu.
     16 please see below for more info on the functions of these buttons:.
     17 
     18 ||'''Red Button: (Service)''' ||This will display the current service info on the display.||
     19 ||'''Green Button: (PIDs)''' ||This will display the PID info on the display.||
     20 ||'''Yellow Button: (Tuner)''' ||This will display the current Tuner Configuration info on the display.||
     21
     22
     23
  • wiki/pages/nl/Settings-Backup-Restore

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2>----
     3>'''3.5.9 Settings Backup Restore''' [=#point3.5.9] ([wiki:Interface-Operation#point3.5 System (Back)]) ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4>
     5>
     6>[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/system_Settings_Backup_Restore.jpg)]][[BR]]
     7>
     8> here you can backup and restore your settings.
     9
     10[[br]]
     11
     12To Exit from the menu press __"Exit"__ to cancel backup restore.
     13
     14
     15'''Coloured Button's Functions"
     16
     17 The __"Coloured Buttons"__ along the bottom of the display bring up additional menus and options with in the backup restore menu. [[BR]]
     18 please see below for more info on the functions of these buttons:.
     19 
     20 ||'''Red Button: (Restore)''' ||Press this button to preform a restore from your previously saved settings.||
     21 ||'''Green Button: (Backup)''' ||Press this button to save your settings.||
     22 ||'''Yellow Button: (Log)''' ||Press this button to see the backup restore log.||
  • wiki/pages/nl/Single-EPG

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2>----
     3>'''3.1.2 Single EPG''' [=#point3.1.2] ([wiki:Interface-Operation#point3.1 Records and EPG(Back)]) ([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4>
     5>[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Single_EPG.jpg)]][[BR]]
     6>
     7Single EPG is a small easy to read vertical epg of a single channel that shows the information of the currently selected program.
     8
     9
     10
     11[[br]]
     12
     13
     14 '''Coloured and Extra Button's Functions"
     15
     16 The __"Coloured and Extra Buttons"__ along the bottom of the display bring up additional menus and options with in the Single EPG menu.
     17 please see below for more info on the functions of these buttons:.
     18 
     19 ||'''Red Button: (Timer)''' ||This will bring up the recording timer menu to set up a timer.||
     20 ||'''0 key (EPG Search):''' ||This will search the EPG for text you specify and bring up a list of matches where you may press the red button to set up a timer.||
     21
     22For information on setting up a timer Recording using the red button see ([wiki:Records Records]) for more info.
     23
     24For information on setting proforming an EPG search using the 0 Key see ([wiki:EPG-Search#point103.10.5 EPG Search]) for more info.
  • wiki/pages/nl/Skin

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2>----
     3>'''3.6.16 Skin''' [=#point3.6.16] ([wiki:Interface-Operation#point3.6 Settings (Back)])([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4>
     5>Menu Picture place holder:
     6>
     7>[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Skin.jpg)]][[BR]]
     8>
     9>here you can select your skin
     10
     11
     12[[br]]
  • wiki/pages/nl/Skin-Adjust

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2>----
     3>'''3.6.7 Skin Adjust''' [=#point3.6.7] ([wiki:Interface-Operation#point3.6 Settings (Back)])([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4>
     5>Menu Picture place holder:
     6>
     7>[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Skin_Adjust.jpg)]][[BR]]
     8>
     9>Here you can edit your skin display settings
     10
     11[[br]]
     12
     13 ||'''Font Zize Adjust in Pixel''' ||Adjust the size of the fonts in the GUI.||
     14 ||'''Listbox Select:''' ||Select the display mode of the listbox select bar.||
     15 ||'''OSD Transparancy:''' ||Set the transpancy of the OSD when it is overlaying the TV display.||
     16 ||'''OSD Left Overscan:''' ||Set the value of the OSD overscan on the left edge of the display.||
     17 ||'''OSD Right Overscan:''' ||Set the value of the OSD overscan on the right edge of the display.||
     18 ||'''OSD Top Overscan:''' ||Set the value of the OSD overscan on the top edge of the display.||
     19 ||'''OSD Bottom Overscan:''' ||Set the value of the OSD overscan on the bottom edge of the display.||
     20 ||'''Show Hdd Freespace:''' ||show the Hdd Free space in the OSD. ||
     21 ||'''Listbox Select Colour:''' ||Press the red button to bring up a colour selection to display for the listbox select bar. ||
     22
     23 
     24 To __"Store"__ the settings Exit from the EPG Settings Menu by pressing __"OK"__ or press __"Exit"__ to cancel changes.
     25 
     26[[br]]
     27----
  • wiki/pages/nl/Smart-Card-Reader

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2>----
     3>'''3.5.3 Smart Card Reader''' [=#point3.5.3] ([wiki:Interface-Operation#point3.5 System (Back)])([wiki:Wiki#point0 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4>
     5>
     6>
     7>[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/system-Smart_Card_Reader.jpg)]][[BR]]
     8>
     9here you can setup your smart card.
     10
     11[[br]]
     12
     13----
     14
     15 '''Coloured Button's Functions"
     16
     17 The __"Coloured Buttons"__ along the bottom of the display bring up additional menus and options with in the epg settings menu.
     18 please see below for more info on the functions of these buttons:.
     19 
     20 ||'''Red Button: (Reset)''' ||This will reset the selected Smart Card.||
  • wiki/pages/nl/Streaming

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2>----
     3>'''3.7.4 Streaming''' [=#point3.7.4] ([wiki:Interface-Operation#point3.7 Information (Back)])([wiki:Wiki#point0.2 Contents]) ([WikiStart#point0 Main page])
     4>
     5>Menu Picture place holder:
     6>
     7>[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/Streaming.jpg)]][[BR]]
     8>
     9> here you can view information on service info being streamed to another device.
     10
     11[[br]]
     12
  • wiki/pages/nl/prozesslist

    r40892 r40899  
     1[[TranslatedPages]]
     2>----
     3>'''3.7.8.6.8 Prozesslist''' [=#point3.7.8.6.8] ([WikiStart#point3.7.8.6 System Infos (Back])
     4>
     5>
     6>[[Image(source:/wiki/Wiki-Pictures/NL/prozesslist.jpg)]][[br]]
     7>
     8Here you can view the detailed Process info.
     9
     10[[br]]
     11
     12
     13[[br]]
Note: See TracChangeset for help on using the changeset viewer.